blob: a03101dab888567f74004a9d5033ad1c2ee30368 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Christopher Fauletd83fd762021-10-04 08:46:17 +02007 2021/10/04
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200749In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
750regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
751only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
752
753* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
754
755* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
756 starting at one.
757
758* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
759 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
760 first section.
761
762These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
763if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
764section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
765"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
766proxies.
767
768This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
769logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
770to name some config objects like servers for example.
771
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200772See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200773
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100774
7752.4. Conditional blocks
776-----------------------
777
778It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
779some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
780ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
781configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
782versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
783preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
784text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
785lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
786switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
787are defined to form conditional blocks:
788
789 - .if <condition>
790 - .elif <condition>
791 - .else
792 - .endif
793
794The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
795as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
796matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
797there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
798only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
799".elif" of a block.
800
801Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
802ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
803as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
804
805The conditions are currently limited to:
806
807 - an empty string, always returns "false"
808 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
809 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200810 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
811
812The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
813
814 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
815 exists, regardless of its contents
816
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200817 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
818 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
819 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
820
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200821 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
822 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
823
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200824 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
825 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
826 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
827 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
828
829 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
830 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
831 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
832 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
833
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200834Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100835
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200836 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
837 listen mwcli_px
838 bind :1111
839 ...
840 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100841
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200842 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
843 bind :80
844 .endif
845
846 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200847 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200848 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200849 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200850 .endif
851
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200852 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
853 profiling.memory on
854 .endif
855
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200856Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100857
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200858 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100859 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
860 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
861 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
862
863Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
864"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
865fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
866provide advice to the user.
867
868Example:
869
870 .if "${A}"
871 .if "${B}"
872 .notice "A=1, B=1"
873 .elif "${C}"
874 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
875 .elif "${D}"
876 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
877 .else
878 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
879 .endif
880 .else
881 .notice "A=0"
882 .endif
883
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200884 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
885 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
886
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100887
8882.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200889----------------
890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100891Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100892values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
893otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
894numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
895for every keyword. Supported units are :
896
897 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
898 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
899 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
900 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
901 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
902 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
903
904
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009052.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200906-------------
907
908 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
909 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
910 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
911 global
912 daemon
913 maxconn 256
914
915 defaults
916 mode http
917 timeout connect 5000ms
918 timeout client 50000ms
919 timeout server 50000ms
920
921 frontend http-in
922 bind *:80
923 default_backend servers
924
925 backend servers
926 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
927
928
929 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
930 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
931 global
932 daemon
933 maxconn 256
934
935 defaults
936 mode http
937 timeout connect 5000ms
938 timeout client 50000ms
939 timeout server 50000ms
940
941 listen http-in
942 bind *:80
943 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
944
945
946Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
947
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100948 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200949
950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009513. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952--------------------
953
954Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
955are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
956of them have command-line equivalents.
957
958The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
959
960 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200961 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200962 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200963 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200964 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200966 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200967 - description
968 - deviceatlas-json-file
969 - deviceatlas-log-level
970 - deviceatlas-separator
971 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200972 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900973 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200974 - gid
975 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100976 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200977 - h1-case-adjust
978 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100979 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100980 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100981 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyelle0ea2c4f2021-07-09 17:14:30 +0200982 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200983 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200984 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200985 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100986 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200987 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100988 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100989 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200990 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200991 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200992 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200993 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +0100994 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200996 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100997 - presetenv
998 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200999 - uid
1000 - ulimit-n
1001 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001002 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001003 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001004 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001005 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001006 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001007 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001008 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001009 - ssl-default-bind-options
1010 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001011 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001012 - ssl-default-server-options
1013 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001014 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001015 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001016 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001017 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001018 - 51degrees-data-file
1019 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001020 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001021 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001022 - wurfl-data-file
1023 - wurfl-information-list
1024 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001025 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001026 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001027
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001028 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001029 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001030 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001031 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001032 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001033 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001034 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001035 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001036 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001037 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001038 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001039 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001040 - noepoll
1041 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001042 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001043 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001044 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001045 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001046 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001047 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001048 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001049 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001050 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001051 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001052 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001053 - tune.buffers.limit
1054 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001055 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001056 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001057 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001058 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001059 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001060 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001061 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001062 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001063 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001064 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001065 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001066 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001067 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001068 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001069 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1070 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001071 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001072 - tune.maxaccept
1073 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001074 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001075 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001076 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001077 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1078 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001079 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1080 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001081 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001082 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001083 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001084 - tune.sndbuf.client
1085 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001086 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001087 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001088 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001089 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001090 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001091 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001092 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001093 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001094 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001095 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001096 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1097 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1098 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001099 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1100 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001101
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001103 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001104 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001105
1106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011073.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001108------------------------------------
1109
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001110ca-base <dir>
1111 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001112 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1113 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1114 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001115
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001116chroot <jail dir>
1117 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1118 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1119 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1120 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1121 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001122 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001123
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001124cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1125 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1126 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1127 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1128 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1129 set. These sets have the format
1130
1131 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1132
1133 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001134 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001135 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1136 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001137 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1138 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001139 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1140 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1141 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1142 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1143 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1144 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1145 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1146 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1147 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1148 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001149
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001150 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1151 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1152 on the machine's word size.
1153
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001154 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001155 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1156 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1157 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1158 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1159 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1160 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001161
1162 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001163 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1164
1165 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1166 # first 4 CPUs
1167
1168 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1169 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1170 # word size.
1171
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001172 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001173 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001174 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1175 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1176 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1177
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001178 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1179 # and so on.
1180 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1181 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1182 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1183
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001184 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001185 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1186 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1187 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1188
1189 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1190 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1191 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1192
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001193 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1194 # and a thread range.
1195 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1196 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1197 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1198
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001199crt-base <dir>
1200 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001201 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1202 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001203
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001204daemon
1205 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1206 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001207 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1208 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001209
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001210default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001211 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001212 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1213 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1214 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1215 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1216 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1217 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1218 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1219 not start with a slash ('/'):
1220 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1221 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1222
1223 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1224 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1225 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1226 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1227 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1228 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1229 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1230 each of them.
1231
1232 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1233 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1234 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1235 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1236 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1237 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1238 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1239 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1240
1241 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1242 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001243 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001244 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1245 made easily relocatable.
1246
1247 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1248 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1249 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1250 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1251 consistent across all configuration files.
1252
1253 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1254 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1255 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1256 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1257 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1258 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1259 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1260 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1261
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001262deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1263 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001264 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001265
1266deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001267 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001268 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1269
1270deviceatlas-separator <char>
1271 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1272 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1273
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001274deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001275 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1276 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1277 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001278
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001279expose-experimental-directives
1280 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1281 the config file will be rejected.
1282
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001283external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001284 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1285 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001286 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1287 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1288 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1289 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1290 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001291
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001292gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001293 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001294 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1295 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001296 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001297 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001298 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001299
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001300group <group name>
1301 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1302 See also "gid" and "user".
1303
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001304hard-stop-after <time>
1305 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1306
1307 Arguments :
1308 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1309 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1310 SIGUSR1 signal.
1311
1312 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1313 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1314 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1315
1316 Example:
1317 global
1318 hard-stop-after 30s
1319
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001320h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1321 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1322 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1323 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1324 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001325 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001326 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1327 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1328 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1329 specified in a proxy.
1330
1331 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1332 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1333 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1334 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1335 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1336 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1337 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1338
1339 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1340 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1341 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1342 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1343 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1344
1345 Example:
1346 global
1347 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1348
1349 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1350 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1351
1352h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1353 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1354 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1355 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1356 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1357 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1358 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1359 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1360 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1361
1362 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1363 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1364 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1365
1366 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1367 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1368
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001369insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001370 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001371 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1372 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1373 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1374 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1375 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1376 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1377 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001378 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001379 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1380 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1381 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1382 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1383 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1384 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1385 disable it.
1386
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001387insecure-setuid-wanted
1388 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1389 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1390 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1391 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001392 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001393 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001394 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001395 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1396 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001397 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001398 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1399 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1400 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1401 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1402
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001403issuers-chain-path <dir>
1404 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1405 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1406 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001407 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001408 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1409 "issuers-chain-path".
1410 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1411 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1412 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1413 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1414 will share the chain in memory.
1415
Amaury Denoyelle0ea2c4f2021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001416h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1417 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1418 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1419 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1420 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1421 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1422 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1423 the keyword with "no'.
1424
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001425localpeer <name>
1426 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1427 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1428 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1429 the configuration parsing.
1430
1431 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1432 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1433
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001434log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001435 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001436 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001437 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001438 configured with "log global".
1439
1440 <address> can be one of:
1441
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001442 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001443 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1444 port).
1445
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001446 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1447 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1448 port).
1449
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001450 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001451 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1452 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001453 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001454
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001455 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1456 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1457 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1458 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1459 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1460 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1461 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1462 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1463 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1464 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001465 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001466 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1467 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1468 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001469 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1470 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001471
1472 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1473 "fd@2", see above.
1474
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001475 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1476 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1477 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1478 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1479 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1480
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001481 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1482 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001483
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001484 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1485 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1486 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1487 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1488 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1489 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1490 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1491 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1492 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1493 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001494 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1495 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001496
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001497 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1498 one of the following :
1499
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001500 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1501 field is stripped. This is the default.
1502 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1503 rfc3164.
1504
1505 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001506 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1507
1508 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1509 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1510
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001511 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1512 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1513 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1514 designed to be used with a local log server.
1515
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001516 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1517 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1518 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1519 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1520 logger consumes.
1521
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001522 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1523 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1524 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1525 used with a local log server.
1526
1527 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1528 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1529 designed to be used with a local log server.
1530
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001531 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1532 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1533 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1534 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1535
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001536 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1537 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1538 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1539 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1540 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1541
1542 <sample_size>
1543 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1544 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1545 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1546 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1547 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1548
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001549 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001550
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001551 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1552 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1553 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1554
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001555 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1556 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1557 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1558 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001559
1560 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001561 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1562 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1563 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1564 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1565 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1566 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001567
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001568 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001569
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001570log-send-hostname [<string>]
1571 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1572 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1573 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1574 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1575 the logs.
1576
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001577log-tag <string>
1578 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1579 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1580 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001581 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001582
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001583lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001584 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1585 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1586 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1587 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1588 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1589 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001590 used multiple times.
1591
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001592lua-load-per-thread <file>
1593 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1594 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1595 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1596 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1597 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1598 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1599 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1600 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1601 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1602 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1603 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1604 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1605 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1606 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1607 times.
1608
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001609lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1610 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1611 variable.
1612 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1613 to "path".
1614
1615 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1616 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1617 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1618 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1619 will be checked earlier.
1620
1621 As an example by specifying the following path:
1622
1623 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1624 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1625
1626 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1627 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1628 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1629 paths if that does not exist either.
1630
1631 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1632 documentation.
1633
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001634master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001635 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1636 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1637 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001638 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001639 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1640 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001641 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1642 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1643 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1644 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1645 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001646
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001647 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001648
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001649mworker-max-reloads <number>
1650 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001651 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001652 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1653 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1654 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1655
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001656nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001657 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1658 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1659 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001660 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1661 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001662 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1663 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1664 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001665
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001666nbthread <number>
1667 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001668 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001669 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1670 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1671 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1672 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001673 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1674 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1675 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1676 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1677 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1678 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1679 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001680
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001681numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001682 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001683 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1684 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1685 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1686 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1687 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1688 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1689 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1690 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001692pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001693 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1694 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1695 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1696 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001697
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001698pp2-never-send-local
1699 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1700 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1701 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1702 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1703 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1704 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1705 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1706 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1707 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1708 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1709 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1710
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001711presetenv <name> <value>
1712 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1713 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1714 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1715 and "unsetenv".
1716
1717resetenv [<name> ...]
1718 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1719 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1720 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1721 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1722 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1723 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1724 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1725 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1726
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001727stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001728 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1729 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1730 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1731 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1732 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1733 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001734 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001735 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1736 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1737 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1738 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001739
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001740server-state-base <directory>
1741 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001742 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1743 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001744
1745server-state-file <file>
1746 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1747 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1748 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1749 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1750 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1751 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1752 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1753 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001754 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1755 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001756
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001757set-var <var-name> <expr>
1758 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1759 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1760 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1761 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1762 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1763 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1764 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1765 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1766 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1767
1768 Example:
1769 global
1770 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1771 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1772 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1773
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001774setenv <name> <value>
1775 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1776 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1777 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1778 and "unsetenv".
1779
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001780set-dumpable
1781 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001782 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1783 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1784 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1785 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1786 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1787 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1788 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1789 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1790 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1791 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1792 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1793 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1794 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1795 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1796 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001797 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001798 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001799
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001800ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1801 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1802 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001803 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001804 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001805 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1806 information and recommendations see e.g.
1807 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1808 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1809 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1810 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001811
1812ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1814 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1815 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1816 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1817 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001818 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1819 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1820 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001821 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001822
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001823ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1824 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1825 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1826 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1827 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1828 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1829
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001830ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1831 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1832 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1833 keyword to see available options.
1834
1835 Example:
1836 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001837 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001838
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001839ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1841 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001842 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001843 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001844 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1845 information and recommendations see e.g.
1846 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1847 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1848 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1849 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1850 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001851
1852ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1854 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1855 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1856 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1857 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001858 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1859 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1860 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1861 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001862
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001863ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1865 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1866 keyword to see available options.
1867
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001868ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1869 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1870 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1871 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001872 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001873 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001874 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1875 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1876 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1877 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001878 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1879 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1880 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1881
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001882ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1883 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1884 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001885 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001886 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001887 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1888
1889 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001890
1891 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1892 and won't try to remove them.
1893
1894 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1895
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001896ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001897 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001898 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1899 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1900 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001901
1902 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1903 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1904 optimize the startup time.
1905
1906 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1907 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1908 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1909
1910 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001911 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001912
1913 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001914 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1915 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001916
1917 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1918 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1919 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1920 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1921 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001922 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001923
1924 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001925 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001926 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1927 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1928 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1929 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1930 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001931 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001932
1933 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1934
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001935 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001936 a cert bundle.
1937
1938 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1939 separately in several "crt".
1940
1941 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1942 since files are loading separately.
1943
1944 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1945 required to commit them.
1946
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001947 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001948 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001949
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001950 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1951 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1952 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001953
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001954 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1955 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1956 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001957
1958 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001959 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1960 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001961
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001962 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1963 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1964
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001965 The default behavior is "all".
1966
1967 Example:
1968 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1969 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1970 ssl-load-extra-files none
1971
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001972 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1973 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001974
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001975ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1976 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1977 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1978 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1979
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001980ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001981 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001982 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1983 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1984 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1985 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1986 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1987 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001988 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001989
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001990stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1991 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1992 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1993 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001994 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001995 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001996
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001997 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1998 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1999 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002000
2001stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2002 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2003 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002004 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002005
2006stats maxconn <connections>
2007 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2008 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2009
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002010uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002011 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002012 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2013 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2014 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2015
2016ulimit-n <number>
2017 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2018 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2019 option.
2020
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002021unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2022 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2023
2024 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2025 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2026 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2027 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2028 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002029 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002030 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2031 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2032 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2033 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2034
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002035unsetenv [<name> ...]
2036 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2037 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2038 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2039 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2040 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2041 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2042 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2043
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002044user <user name>
2045 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2046 See also "uid" and "group".
2047
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002048node <name>
2049 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2050
2051 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2052 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2053 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2054 traffic.
2055
2056description <text>
2057 Add a text that describes the instance.
2058
2059 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2060 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2061 "<" and ">" characters.
2062
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100206351degrees-data-file <file path>
2064 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002065 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002066
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002067 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002068 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2069
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000207051degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002071 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2072 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2073 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2074
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002075 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002076 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2077
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200207851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002079 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2080 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2081
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002082 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002083 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2084
208551degrees-cache-size <number>
2086 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2087 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2088 By default, this cache is disabled.
2089
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002090 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002091 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2092
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002093wurfl-data-file <file path>
2094 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2095 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2096
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002097 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002098 with USE_WURFL=1.
2099
2100wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2101 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2102 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2103 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2104
2105 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2106
2107 Valid WURFL properties are:
2108 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2109
2110 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2111 device.
2112
2113 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2114 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2115
2116 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2117 particular web request.
2118
2119 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2120 used Libwurfl API version.
2121
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002122 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2123 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2124
2125 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2126 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2127
2128 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2129
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002130 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002131 with USE_WURFL=1.
2132
2133wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2134 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2135 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2136
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002137 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002138 with USE_WURFL=1.
2139
2140wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2141 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2142 thus before the chroot.
2143
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002144 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002145 with USE_WURFL=1.
2146
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002147wurfl-cache-size <size>
2148 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2149 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002150 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002151 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002152
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002153 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002154 with USE_WURFL=1.
2155
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002156strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002157 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002158 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2159 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002160 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002161 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021633.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002164-----------------------
2165
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002166busy-polling
2167 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2168 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2169 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2170 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2171 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2172 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2173 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2174 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2175 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2176 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2177 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2178 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2179 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2180 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2181 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2182 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2183 "poll" pollers.
2184
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002185 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2186 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2187 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2188
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002189max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002190 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002191 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2192 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2193 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2194 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2195 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2196 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2197 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2198
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002199maxconn <number>
2200 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2201 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2202 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002203 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2204 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2205 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2206 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002207 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2208 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2209 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2210 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2211 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2212 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002213
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002214maxconnrate <number>
2215 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2216 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2217 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2218 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2219 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2220 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2221 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2222 fairness.
2223
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002224maxcomprate <number>
2225 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002226 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002227 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2228 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2229 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002230 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002231 default value.
2232
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002233maxcompcpuusage <number>
2234 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2235 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2236 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002237 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. In
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002238 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2239 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2240 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2241 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2242
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002243maxpipes <number>
2244 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2245 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2246 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2247 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2248 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2249 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2250
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002251maxsessrate <number>
2252 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2253 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2254 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2255 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2256 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2257 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2258 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2259 fairness.
2260
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002261maxsslconn <number>
2262 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2263 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2264 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2265 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2266 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2267 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2268 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002269 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2270 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2271 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2272 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002273 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002274 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2275 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002276
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002277maxsslrate <number>
2278 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2279 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2280 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2281 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2282 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2283 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2284 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2285 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2286 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2287 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2288
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002289maxzlibmem <number>
2290 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2291 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2292 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002293 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2294 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2295 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2296
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002297noepoll
2298 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2299 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002300 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002301
2302nokqueue
2303 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2304 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2305 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2306
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002307noevports
2308 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2309 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2310 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2311 also "nopoll".
2312
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002313nopoll
2314 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2315 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002316 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002317 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2318 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002319
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002320nosplice
2321 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002322 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002323 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002324 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002325 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2326 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2327 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2328 "option splice-response".
2329
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002330nogetaddrinfo
2331 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2332 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2333
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002334noreuseport
2335 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2336 command line argument "-dR".
2337
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002338profiling.memory { on | off }
2339 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2340 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2341 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2342 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2343 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2344 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2345 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2346 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2347 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2348
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002349profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2350 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2351 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2352 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2353 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002354 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002355 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2356 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2357 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2358 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2359
2360 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2361 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2362 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2363 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2364 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002365 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2366 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2367 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2368 CLI.
2369
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002370spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002371 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2372 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2373 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2374 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2375 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2376 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002377
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002378ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002379 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002380 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002381 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002382 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002383 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2384 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2385 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002386 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2387 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002388 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2389 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2390 openssl configuration file uses:
2391 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2392
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002393ssl-mode-async
2394 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002395 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002396 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2397 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002398 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002399 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002400 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002401
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002402tune.buffers.limit <number>
2403 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2404 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2405 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2406 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2407 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002408 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002409 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2410 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2411 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2412 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2413 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2414 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2415 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2416 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002417 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002418
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002419tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2420 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2421 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2422 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002423 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002424
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002425tune.bufsize <number>
2426 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2427 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2428 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2429 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2430 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2431 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2432 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002433 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2434 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002435 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002436 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002437 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002438 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2439 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002440
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002441tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2442 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002443
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002444tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2445 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2446 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2447 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2448 this value. The default value is 1.
2449
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002450tune.fail-alloc
2451 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2452 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2453 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2454 gracefully.
2455
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002456tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2457 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2458 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2459 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2460 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2461 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2462
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002463tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2464 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2465 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2466 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2467 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2468 change it.
2469
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002470tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2471 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002472 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002473 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002474 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2475 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2476 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2477 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2478 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2479
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002480tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2481 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2482 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2483 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2484 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2485 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002486 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002487 recommended not to change this value.
2488
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002489tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002490 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002491 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002492 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002493 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2494 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2495 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2496 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2497
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002498tune.http.cookielen <number>
2499 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2500 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2501 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2502 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2503 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2504 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2505 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2506 to change this value.
2507
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002508tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002509 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2510 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002511 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002512 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002513 configuration directives too.
2514 The default value is 1024.
2515
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002516tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2517 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2518 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2519 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2520 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2521 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2522 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002523 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2524 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2525 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002526
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002527tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2528 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2529 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2530 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2531 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2532 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2533 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002534 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2535 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2536 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2537 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2538 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002539
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002540tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002541 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002542 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2543 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2544 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2545 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002546 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002547 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002548 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002549 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2550
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002551tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2552 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2553 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2554 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2555 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2556 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2557 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2558 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2559 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2560 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2561
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002562tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2563 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002564 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002565 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2566 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002567 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002568 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2569 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2570
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002571tune.lua.maxmem
2572 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2573 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2574 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2575 memory.
2576
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002577tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2578 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002579 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2580 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002581 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002582
2583tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2584 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2585 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2586 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2587 check servers.
2588
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002589tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2590 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2591 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2592 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002593 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002594
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002595tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002596 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2597 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002598 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2599 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2600 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2601 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2602 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2603 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2604 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2605 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2606 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002607
2608tune.maxpollevents <number>
2609 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2610 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2611 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2612 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2613 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2614
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002615tune.maxrewrite <number>
2616 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2617 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2618 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2619 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2620 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2621 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2622 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2623 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2624 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2625 bufsize.
2626
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002627tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2628 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2629 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2630 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2631 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2632 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2633 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2634 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2635 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2636 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002637 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2638 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002639 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2640 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2641 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2642 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2643 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2644 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2645 setting this parameter to 0.
2646
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002647tune.pipesize <number>
2648 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2649 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2650 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2651 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2652 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2653 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2654
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002655tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2656 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002657 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002658 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2659 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2660 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2661 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002662 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002663
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002664tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2665 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002666 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002667 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2668 default is 20.
2669
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002670tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2671tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2672 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2673 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2674 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002675 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002676 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002677 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2678 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2679
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002680tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002681 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002682 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2683 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2684 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2685 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2686
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002687tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002688 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002689 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2690 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2691 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2692 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2693 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2694 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2695 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002696
2697tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2698 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002699 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002700 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2701 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2702 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2703 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2704 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2705 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2706 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002707
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002708tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2709tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2710 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2711 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2712 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002713 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002714 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002715 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2716 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2717 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2718 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002719 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002720
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002721tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002722 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002723 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2724 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2725 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2726 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2727 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2728 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2729 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2730 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2731 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2732 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2733 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002734
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002735tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002736 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002737 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2738 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2739 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2740 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2741 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2742
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002743tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2744 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2745 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2746 performances. This is disabled by default.
2747
2748 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2749 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2750
2751 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2752
2753 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2754
2755 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2756
2757 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2758 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2759 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2760
2761 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2762 converted.
2763
2764 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2765 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2766 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2767 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2768 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2769 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2770 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002771 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2772 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002773
2774 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2775
2776 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2777 only need this line:
2778
2779 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2780
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002781tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2782 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002783 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002784 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2785 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2786 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2787 being used for too long.
2788
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002789tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2790 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2791 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2792 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2793 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2794 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2795 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2796 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2797 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2798 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2799 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002800 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002801 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002802
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002803tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2804 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2805 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2806 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2807 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002808 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002809 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2810 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002811 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2812 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002813
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002814tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2815 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2816 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2817 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2818 1000 entries.
2819
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002820tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2821 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2822 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2823 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2824
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002825tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002826tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002827tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2828tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2829tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002830 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2831 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2832 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2833 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2834 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2835 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2836 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2837 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002838
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002839 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2840 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2841 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2842 all available space is consumed.
2843 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2844 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2845 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002846
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002847tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2848 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002849 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002850 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002851 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002852 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2853
2854tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2855 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2856 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002857 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2858 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028603.3. Debugging
2861--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002862
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002863quiet
2864 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2865 line argument "-q".
2866
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002867zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002868 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002869 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2870 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2871 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2872 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2873 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2874
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002875
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028763.4. Userlists
2877--------------
2878It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2879http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2880it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2881
2882userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002883 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002884 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2885
2886group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002887 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002888 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2889 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2890
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002891user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2892 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002893 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2894 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002895 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2896 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2897 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2898 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002899
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002900 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2901 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2902 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2903 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2904 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2905 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2906 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002907 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002908 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002909
2910 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002911 userlist L1
2912 group G1 users tiger,scott
2913 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002914
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002915 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2916 user scott insecure-password elgato
2917 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002918
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002919 userlist L2
2920 group G1
2921 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002922
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002923 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2924 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2925 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002926
2927 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002928
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002929
29303.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002931----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002932It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002933several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002934instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2935values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2936automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2937In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2938using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2939tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2940reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2941Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2942that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2943each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002944
2945peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002946 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002947 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2948
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002949bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2950 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2951 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2952
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002953disabled
2954 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2955 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2956 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2957
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002958default-bind [param*]
2959 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2960
2961default-server [param*]
2962 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2963
2964 Arguments:
2965 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2966 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2967 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2968 details.
2969
2970
2971 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2972
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02002973enabled
2974 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
2975 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002976
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002977log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002978 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2979 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2980 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2981 more details.
2982
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002983peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002984 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2985 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002986 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002987 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002988 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2989 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2990 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002991
2992 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2993 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2994
2995 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002996 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2997 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2998 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002999
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003000 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3001 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003002
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003003 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3004 "server" keyword explanation below).
3005
3006server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003007 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003008 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
3009 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
3010 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
3011 of this "peers" section).
3012 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3013
3014
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003015 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003016 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003017 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003018 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3019 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3020 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003021
3022 backend mybackend
3023 mode tcp
3024 balance roundrobin
3025 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3026 stick on src
3027
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003028 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3029 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003030
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003031 Example:
3032 peers mypeers
3033 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3034 default-server ssl verify none
3035 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3036 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003037
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003038
3039table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3040 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3041
3042 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3043 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003044 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003045 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3046 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3047 "stick-table" keyword).
3048
3049 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3050 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3051 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3052 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3053 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3054 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3055 of the stick-table name as follows:
3056
3057 peers mypeers
3058 peer A ...
3059 peer B ...
3060 table t1 ...
3061
3062 frontend fe1
3063 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3064
3065 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3066 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3067
3068 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3069 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3070 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3071 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3072 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3073 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3074 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3075
3076 peers mypeers
3077 peer A ...
3078 peer B ...
3079 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3080
3081 backend t1
3082 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3083
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003084 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003085 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3086 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3087
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030883.6. Mailers
3089------------
3090It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3091If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3092in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3093
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003094mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003095 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3096 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3097
3098mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3099 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3100
3101 Example:
3102 mailers mymailers
3103 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3104 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3105
3106 backend mybackend
3107 mode tcp
3108 balance roundrobin
3109
3110 email-alert mailers mymailers
3111 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3112 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3113
3114 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3115 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3116
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003117timeout mail <time>
3118 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3119 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3120 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3121 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3122
3123 Example:
3124 mailers mymailers
3125 timeout mail 20s
3126 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003127
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031283.7. Programs
3129-------------
3130In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3131master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3132managed the same way as the workers.
3133
3134During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3135sequence as a worker:
3136
3137 - the master is re-executed
3138 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3139 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3140 instance of the program
3141
3142During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3143
3144program <name>
3145 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3146 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3147 the management guide).
3148
3149command <command> [arguments*]
3150 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3151 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3152 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3153 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3154
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003155user <user name>
3156 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3157 See also "group".
3158
3159group <group name>
3160 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3161 See also "user".
3162
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003163option start-on-reload
3164no option start-on-reload
3165 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3166 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3167 program section.
3168
3169
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031703.8. HTTP-errors
3171----------------
3172
3173It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3174imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3175several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3176
3177http-errors <name>
3178 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3179 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3180
3181errorfile <code> <file>
3182 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3183
3184 Arguments :
3185 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003186 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003187 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003188
3189 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3190 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3191 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3192 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3193 before any chroot is performed.
3194
3195 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3196
3197 Example:
3198 http-errors website-1
3199 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3200 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3201 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3202
3203 http-errors website-2
3204 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3205 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3206 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3207
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032083.9. Rings
3209----------
3210
3211It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3212servers or traces.
3213
3214ring <ringname>
3215 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3216
3217description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003218 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003219 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3220
3221format <format>
3222 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3223
3224 Arguments:
3225 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3226 one of the following :
3227
3228 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3229 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3230 designed to be used with a local log server.
3231
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003232 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3233 field is stripped. This is the default.
3234 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3235 rfc3164.
3236
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003237 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3238 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3239 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3240 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3241 is the default.
3242
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003243 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003244 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3245
3246 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3247 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3248
3249 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3250 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3251 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3252 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3253 logger consumes.
3254
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003255 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3256 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3257 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3258 with a local log server.
3259
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003260 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3261 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3262 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3263 used with a local log server.
3264
3265maxlen <length>
3266 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3267 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3268 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3269
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003270server <name> <address> [param*]
3271 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3272 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3273 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3274 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3275 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3276 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3277 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3278 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3279 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003280 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3281 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003282
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003283size <size>
3284 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3285 set to BUFSIZE.
3286
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003287timeout connect <timeout>
3288 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3289
3290 Arguments :
3291 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3292 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3293 as explained at the top of this document.
3294
3295timeout server <timeout>
3296 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3297
3298 Arguments :
3299 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3300 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3301 as explained at the top of this document.
3302
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003303 Example:
3304 global
3305 log ring@myring local7
3306
3307 ring myring
3308 description "My local buffer"
3309 format rfc3164
3310 maxlen 1200
3311 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003312 timeout connect 5s
3313 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003314 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003315
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033163.10. Log forwarding
3317-------------------
3318
3319It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003320HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003321
3322log-forward <name>
3323 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3324
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003325backlog <conns>
3326 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3327 on connections accept.
3328
3329bind <addr> [param*]
3330 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003331 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3332 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3333 syslog protocol over TCP.
3334 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003335 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3336
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003337dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003338 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3339 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3340 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3341 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003342 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003343
3344log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003345log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003346 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3347 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3348 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003349 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003350 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3351 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3352 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003353 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003354
3355 Example:
3356 global
3357 log stderr format iso local7
3358
3359 ring myring
3360 description "My local buffer"
3361 format rfc5424
3362 maxlen 1200
3363 size 32764
3364 timeout connect 5s
3365 timeout server 10s
3366 # syslog tcp server
3367 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3368
3369 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003370 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3371 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003372 # all messages on stderr
3373 log global
3374 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3375 log ring@myring local0
3376 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3377 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3378 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3379 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3380 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003381
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003382maxconn <conns>
3383 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3384 10 is the default.
3385
3386timeout client <timeout>
3387 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033894. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003390----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003391
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003392Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003393 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3394 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3395 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3396 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003397
3398A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3399connections.
3400
3401A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3402to forward incoming connections.
3403
3404A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3405parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3406
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003407A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3408ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3409sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3410the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3411explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3412from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3413"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3414for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3415to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3416optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3417are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3418any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3419names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3420that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3421duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3422names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3423
3424Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3425settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3426of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3427profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3428timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3429
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003430All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3431'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3432case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3433
3434Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3435logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3436proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3437However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3438name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3439
3440Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3441and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003442bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003443protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3444modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3445arbitrary criteria.
3446
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003447In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3448a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003449the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003450
3451 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3452 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3453 between responses and new requests.
3454
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003455 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3456 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3457 client-facing connection remains open.
3458
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003459 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3460 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003461
3462The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3463frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3464following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003465weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003466
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003467 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003468
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003469 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3470 ----+-----+-----+----
3471 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3472 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003473 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3474 ----+-----+-----+----
3475 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003476
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003477It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003478only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3479within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003480as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003481content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003482and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3483possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003484
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003485There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003486first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003487processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003488second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003489protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3490is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3491new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003492to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003493process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3494already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3495HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3496evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3497one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3498
3499There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3500performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3501tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3502preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3503analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3504HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3505header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3506mitigate this drawback.
3507
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003508There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003509method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3510set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3511in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3512is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3513to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3514above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3515to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3516"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3517frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3518frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3519as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3520upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3521on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3522the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3523upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3524frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3525remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003526
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035274.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3528--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003530The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3531limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3532they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3533limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003534marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003535option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003536and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3537with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3538specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003539
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003540
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003541 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3542------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3543acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003544backlog X X X -
3545balance X - X X
3546bind - X X -
3547bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003548capture cookie - X X -
3549capture request header - X X -
3550capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003551clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3552clitcpka-idle X X X -
3553clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003554compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003555cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003556declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003557default-server X - X X
3558default_backend X X X -
3559description - X X X
3560disabled X X X X
3561dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003562email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003563email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003564email-alert mailers X X X X
3565email-alert myhostname X X X X
3566email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003567enabled X X X X
3568errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003569errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003570errorloc X X X X
3571errorloc302 X X X X
3572-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3573errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003574force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003575filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003576fullconn X - X X
3577grace X X X X
3578hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003579http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003580http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003581http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003582http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003583http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003584http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003585http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003586http-check set-var X - X X
3587http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003588http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003589http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003590http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003591http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003592http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003593id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003594ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003595load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003596log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003597log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003598log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003599log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003600max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003601maxconn X X X -
3602mode X X X X
3603monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003604monitor-uri X X X -
3605option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3606option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3607option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3608option allbackups (*) X - X X
3609option checkcache (*) X - X X
3610option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3611option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003612option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003613option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3614option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003615-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3616option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003617option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3618option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003619option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003620option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003621option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003622option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003623option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003624option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3625option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3626option httpchk X - X X
3627option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003628option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003629option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003630option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003631option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003632option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003633option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3634option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3635option logasap (*) X X X -
3636option mysql-check X - X X
3637option nolinger (*) X X X X
3638option originalto X X X X
3639option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003640option pgsql-check X - X X
3641option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003642option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003643option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003644option smtpchk X - X X
3645option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3646option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3647option splice-request (*) X X X X
3648option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003649option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003650option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3651option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3652-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003653option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3655option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3656option tcpka X X X X
3657option tcplog X X X X
3658option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003659external-check command X - X X
3660external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003661persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3662rate-limit sessions X X X -
3663redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003664-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003665retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003666retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003667server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003668server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003669server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003670source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003671srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3672srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3673srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003674stats admin - X X X
3675stats auth X X X X
3676stats enable X X X X
3677stats hide-version X X X X
3678stats http-request - X X X
3679stats realm X X X X
3680stats refresh X X X X
3681stats scope X X X X
3682stats show-desc X X X X
3683stats show-legends X X X X
3684stats show-node X X X X
3685stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003686-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3687stick match - - X X
3688stick on - - X X
3689stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003690stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003691stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003692tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003693tcp-check connect X - X X
3694tcp-check expect X - X X
3695tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003696tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003697tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003698tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003699tcp-check set-var X - X X
3700tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003701tcp-request connection - X X -
3702tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003703tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003704tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003705tcp-response content - - X X
3706tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003707timeout check X - X X
3708timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003709timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003710timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003711timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3712timeout http-request X X X X
3713timeout queue X - X X
3714timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003715timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003716timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003717timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003718transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003719unique-id-format X X X -
3720unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003721use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003722use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003723use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003724------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3725 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003726
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037284.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3729---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003730
3731This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3732
3733
3734acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3735 Declare or complete an access list.
3736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3737 no | yes | yes | yes
3738 Example:
3739 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3740 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3741 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003743 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003744
3745
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003746backlog <conns>
3747 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3749 yes | yes | yes | no
3750 Arguments :
3751 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3752 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003753 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003754
3755 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3756 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3757 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3758 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3759 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3760 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3761 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3762 backlog parameter.
3763
3764 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3765 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3766 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3767
3768 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3769
3770
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003771balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003772balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003773 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3775 yes | no | yes | yes
3776 Arguments :
3777 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3778 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3779 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3780 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3781
3782 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3783 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3784 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3785 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003786 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003787 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003788 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3789 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3790 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3791 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3792 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3793 it, so that you don't worry.
3794
3795 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3796 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3797 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3798 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3799 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3800 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3801 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3802 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003803
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003804 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3805 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3806 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3807 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3808 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3809 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3810 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003811 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3812 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3813 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003814
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003815 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003816 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003817 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3818 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003819 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003820 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3821 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3822 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3823 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3824 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003825 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3826 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3827 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3828 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3829 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3830 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003831
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003832 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3833 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3834 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3835 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3836 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3837 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3838 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3839 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003840 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003841 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003842 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3843 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3844 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003845
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003846 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3847 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3848 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3849 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3850 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3851 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3852 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3853 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3854 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3855 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3856 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3857 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003858
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003859 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003860 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3861 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3862 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3863 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3864 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3865 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3866 URIs start with a leading "/".
3867
3868 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3869 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3870 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3871 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3872
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003873 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3874 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3875 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3876 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003878 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003879 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3880
3881 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003882 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3883 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003884 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3885 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3886 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3887 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003888 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003889 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3890 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003891
3892 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3893 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3894 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3895 server will receive the request.
3896
3897 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3898 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3899 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3900 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3901 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003902 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3903 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3904 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003905
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003906 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3907 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3908 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3909 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3910 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003912 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003913 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3914 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3915 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3916
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003917 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3918 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3919 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3920
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003921 random
3922 random(<draws>)
3923 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003924 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3925 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3926 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3927 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003928 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3929 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3930 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3931 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3932 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3933 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3934 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3935 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3936 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3937 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3938 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3939 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3940 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3941 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3942 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3943 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3944 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3945 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3946 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3947 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003948
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003949 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003950 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003951 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3952 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3953 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3954 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3955 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3956 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003957 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003958 used instead.
3959
3960 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3961 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3962 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3963 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3964
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003965 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3966 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3967 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3968
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003969 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003970
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003971 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003972 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3973 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003974
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003975 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3976 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3977 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003978
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003979 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003980 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003981 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3982 NTLM relies on.
3983
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003984 Examples :
3985 balance roundrobin
3986 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003987 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003988 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3989 balance hdr(host)
3990 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003991
3992 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3993 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003995 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003996 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3997 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3998 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003999 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004000
4001 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4002 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4003 defaults to 16 kB.
4004
4005 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4006 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4007
4008 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4009 Round Robin.
4010
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004011 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004012 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4013 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4014 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4015
4016 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4017
4018 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004019 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004020 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4021 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4022 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004023
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004024 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004025
4026
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004027bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4028bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004029 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4031 no | yes | yes | no
4032 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004033 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4034 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4035 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4036 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004037 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004038 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4039 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4040 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4041 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4042 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4043 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004044 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004045 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4046 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004047 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004048 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4049 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004050 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004051 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4052 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004053 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004054 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4055 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4056 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4057 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4058 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4059 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4060 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004061 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4062 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4063 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004064 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4065 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4066 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4067 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004068 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4069 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4070 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004071
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004072 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4073 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004074 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4075 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4076 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004077 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4078 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4079 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4080 the range.
4081
4082 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4083 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4084 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4085 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4086 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4087 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4088 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004089 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004090 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004091
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004092 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004093 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004094 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4095 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4096 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4097 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4098 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4099 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4100
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004101 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4102 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4103 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4104 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004105
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004106 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4107 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4108 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4109 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4110 in a frontend.
4111
4112 Example :
4113 listen http_proxy
4114 bind :80,:443
4115 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004116 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004117
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004118 listen http_https_proxy
4119 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004120 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004121
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004122 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4123 bind ipv6@:80
4124 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4125 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4126
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004127 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004128 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004129
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004130 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4131 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4132 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4133 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4134 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4135
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004136 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004137 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004138
4139
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004140bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004141 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4143 yes | yes | yes | yes
4144 Arguments :
4145 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4146 may be used to override a default value.
4147
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004148 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004149 option may be combined with other numbers.
4150
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004151 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004152 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4153 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4154 missing from all processes.
4155
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004156 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004157 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004158 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4159 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4160 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4161 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4162 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004163 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004164
4165 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4166 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4167 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4168 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4169 and 'even' instances.
4170
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004171 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4172 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4173 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4174 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004175
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004176 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4177 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4178
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004179 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4180 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4181 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4182
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004183 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4184 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4185
4186 Example :
4187 listen app_ip1
4188 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004189 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004190
4191 listen app_ip2
4192 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004193 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004194
4195 listen management
4196 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004197 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004198
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004199 listen management
4200 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4201 bind-process 1-4
4202
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004203 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004204
4205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004206capture cookie <name> len <length>
4207 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4209 no | yes | yes | no
4210 Arguments :
4211 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4212 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4213 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4214 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004215 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004216
4217 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4218 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4219 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4220 right if it exceeds <length>.
4221
4222 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4223 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4224 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4225 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4226
4227 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4228 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4229 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4230
4231 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4232 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4233 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004234 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4235 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4236 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004237
4238 Example:
4239 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4240
4241 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004242 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004243
4244
4245capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004246 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4248 no | yes | yes | no
4249 Arguments :
4250 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004251 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004252 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4253 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4254 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4255
4256 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4257 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4258 it exceeds <length>.
4259
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004260 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004261 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4262 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004263 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4264 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4265 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4266 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004267 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004268 environments to find where the request came from.
4269
4270 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4271 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4272 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4273 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004274
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004275 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4276 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4277 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4278 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4279 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004280
4281 Example:
4282 capture request header Host len 15
4283 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004284 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004286 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004287 about logging.
4288
4289
4290capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004291 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4293 no | yes | yes | no
4294 Arguments :
4295 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004296 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004297 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4298 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4299 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4300
4301 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4302 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4303 it exceeds <length>.
4304
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004305 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004306 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4307 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4308 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004309 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4310 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4311 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4312 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004313
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004314 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4315 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4316 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4317 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4318 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004319
4320 Example:
4321 capture response header Content-length len 9
4322 capture response header Location len 15
4323
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004324 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004325 about logging.
4326
4327
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004328clitcpka-cnt <count>
4329 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4330 the connection on the client side.
4331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4332 yes | yes | yes | no
4333 Arguments :
4334 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4335
4336 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4337 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004338 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4339 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004340
4341 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4342
4343
4344clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4345 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4346 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4347 client side.
4348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4349 yes | yes | yes | no
4350 Arguments :
4351 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4352 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4353 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4354 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4355
4356 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4357 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004358 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4359 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004360
4361 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4362
4363
4364clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4365 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4367 yes | yes | yes | no
4368 Arguments :
4369 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4370 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4371 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4372 document.
4373
4374 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4375 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004376 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4377 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004378
4379 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4380
4381
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004382compression algo <algorithm> ...
4383compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004384compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004385 Enable HTTP compression.
4386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4387 yes | yes | yes | yes
4388 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004389 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4390 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004391 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004392
4393 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004394 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4395 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4396 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004397
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004398 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004399 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004400
4401 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4402 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4403 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4404 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4405 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004406 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004407
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004408 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4409 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4410 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4411 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4412 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4413 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4414 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004415 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004416
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004417 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004418 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004419 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004420 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004421 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004422 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004423 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004424
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004425 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004426 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4427 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004428 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4429 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004430 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004431 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004432 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4433 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004434 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004435 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4436 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004437
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004438 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004439 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4440 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004441 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004442 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004443 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4444 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4445 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4446 "multipart"
4447 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4448 header
4449 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4450 and later
4451 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4452 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004453 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004454
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004455 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004456
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004457 Examples :
4458 compression algo gzip
4459 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004460
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004461
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004462cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004463 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4464 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004465 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004466 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4468 yes | no | yes | yes
4469 Arguments :
4470 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4471 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4472 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4473 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4474 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4475 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004476 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004477 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4478 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4479
4480 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004481 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004482 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4483 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4484 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4485 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004486 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4487 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004488 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004489 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4490 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004491
4492 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004493 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004494
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004495 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004496 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004497 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004498 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004499 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4500 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4501 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4502 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4503 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4504 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4505 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004506
4507 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4508 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4509 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4510 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4511 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4512 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4513 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4514 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4515 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004516 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004517 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4518 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4519 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004520
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004521 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4522 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4523 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004524 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4525 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4526 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4527 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004528 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4529 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4530 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004531
4532 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4533 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4534 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4535 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4536 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4537 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4538 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4539 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4540 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4541
4542 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4543 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4544 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4545 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4546 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4547 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4548 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4549 persistence cookie in the cache.
4550 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4551
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004552 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4553 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004554 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004555 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4556 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004557 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004558 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4559 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4560 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4561 they logout.
4562
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004563 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004564 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4565 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4566 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4567
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004568 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004569 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4570 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4571 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4572 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4573 this attribute.
4574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004575 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004576 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004577 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4578 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4579 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4580 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4581 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4582 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004583
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004584 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4585 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4586 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4587 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4588 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4589 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4590 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4591 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004592 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004593 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4594 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4595 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4596 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4597 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4598 the site.
4599
4600 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4601 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4602 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4603 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4604 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4605 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4606 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4607 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4608 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4609 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4610 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4611 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4612 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004613 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004614 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4615 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4616
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004617 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4618 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4619 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4620 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4621 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4622 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4623
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004624 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004625 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4626 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4627 repeated.
4628
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004629 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4630 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4631 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4632 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004634 Examples :
4635 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4636 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4637 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004638 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004639
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004640 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004641
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004642
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004643declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4644 Declares a capture slot.
4645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4646 no | yes | yes | no
4647 Arguments:
4648 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4649
4650 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4651 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4652 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4653 for use in the response.
4654
4655 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004656 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004657 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4658
4659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004660default-server [param*]
4661 Change default options for a server in a backend
4662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4663 yes | no | yes | yes
4664 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004665 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4666 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4667 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4668 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004669
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004670 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004671 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4672
4673 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004674
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004675
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004676default_backend <backend>
4677 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4679 yes | yes | yes | no
4680 Arguments :
4681 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4682
4683 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4684 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4685 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4686 will catch all undetermined requests.
4687
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004688 Example :
4689
4690 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4691 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4692 default_backend dynamic
4693
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004694 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004696
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004697description <string>
4698 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4700 no | yes | yes | yes
4701 Arguments : string
4702
4703 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4704 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4705 it describes.
4706 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4707
4708
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004709disabled
4710 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4712 yes | yes | yes | yes
4713 Arguments : none
4714
4715 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4716 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4717 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4718 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4719 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4720 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4721 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4722
4723 See also : "enabled"
4724
4725
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004726dispatch <address>:<port>
4727 Set a default server address
4728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4729 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004730 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004731
4732 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4733 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4734 during start-up.
4735
4736 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4737 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4738 possible with normal servers.
4739
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004740 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004741 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4742 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4743 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4744 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4745
4746 See also : "server"
4747
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004748
4749dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4750 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4752 yes | no | yes | yes
4753 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4754
4755 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004756 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004757 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4758 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004759 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004760 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004762enabled
4763 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4765 yes | yes | yes | yes
4766 Arguments : none
4767
4768 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4769 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4770
4771 See also : "disabled"
4772
4773
4774errorfile <code> <file>
4775 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4777 yes | yes | yes | yes
4778 Arguments :
4779 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004780 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004781 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004782
4783 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004784 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004785 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004786 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4787 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004788
4789 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4790 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4791 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4792
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004793 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4794
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004795 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4796 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4797 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4798 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4799 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4800 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4801 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4802 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4803 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004804
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004805 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4806 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4807 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004808 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004809 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4810
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004811 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004812
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004813 Example :
4814 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004815 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004816 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4817 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4818
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004819
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004820errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4821 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4822 section.
4823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4824 yes | yes | yes | yes
4825 Arguments :
4826 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4827
4828 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004829 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004830 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4831 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004832
4833 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4834 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4835 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4836 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4837 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004838 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004839 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4840
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004841 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4842 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004843
4844 Example :
4845 errorfiles generic
4846 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4847
4848
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004849errorloc <code> <url>
4850errorloc302 <code> <url>
4851 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4853 yes | yes | yes | yes
4854 Arguments :
4855 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004856 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004857 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004858
4859 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4860 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4861 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4862 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004863 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004864
4865 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4866 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4867 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4868
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004869 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4870
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004871 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4872 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4873 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4874 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004875 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004876 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4877 request.
4878
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004879 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004880
4881
4882errorloc303 <code> <url>
4883 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4885 yes | yes | yes | yes
4886 Arguments :
4887 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004888 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004889 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004890
4891 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4892 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4893 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4894 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004895 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004896
4897 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4898 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4899 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4900
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004901 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004903 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4904 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4905 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4906 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004907 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004908
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004909 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004910
4911
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004912email-alert from <emailaddr>
4913 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004914 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004915 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4916 yes | yes | yes | yes
4917
4918 Arguments :
4919
4920 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4921
4922 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4923 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4924
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004925 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004926 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4927 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004928
4929
4930email-alert level <level>
4931 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4932 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 yes | yes | yes | yes
4935
4936 Arguments :
4937
4938 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4939 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4940 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4941
4942 By default level is alert
4943
4944 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4945 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4946 for the proxy.
4947
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004948 Alerts are sent when :
4949
4950 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4951 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4952 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4953 is notice or lower
4954 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4955 and a health check status update occurs
4956
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004957 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4958 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004959 section 3.6 about mailers.
4960
4961
4962email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4963 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4965 yes | yes | yes | yes
4966
4967 Arguments :
4968
4969 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4970
4971 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4972 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4973
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004974 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4975 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004976
4977
4978email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4979 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4980 mailers.
4981 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4982 yes | yes | yes | yes
4983
4984 Arguments :
4985
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004986 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004987
4988 By default the systems hostname is used.
4989
4990 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4991 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4992 for the proxy.
4993
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004994 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4995 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004996
4997
4998email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004999 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005000 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5002 yes | yes | yes | yes
5003
5004 Arguments :
5005
5006 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5007
5008 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5009 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5010
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005011 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005012 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5013
5014
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005015force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5016 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5017 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005018 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005019
5020 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5021 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5022 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5023 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5024 marked down for maintenance operations.
5025
5026 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5027 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5028 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5029 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5030 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5031 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5032 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5033 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5034 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5035
5036 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5037 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5038 is used.
5039
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005040 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005041 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005042
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005043
5044filter <name> [param*]
5045 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5047 no | yes | yes | yes
5048 Arguments :
5049 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5050 referenced in section 9.
5051
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005052 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005053 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005054 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5055 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005056
5057 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5058 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5059
5060 Example:
5061 listen
5062 bind *:80
5063
5064 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5065 filter compression
5066 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5067
5068 compression algo gzip
5069 compression offload
5070
5071 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5072
5073 See also : section 9.
5074
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005075
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005076fullconn <conns>
5077 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5079 yes | no | yes | yes
5080 Arguments :
5081 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5082 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5083
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005084 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005085 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005086 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005087 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5088 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5089 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5090 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5091 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005092 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005093
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005094 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005095 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005096 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5097 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5098 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005099
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005100 Example :
5101 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5102 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5103 # connections.
5104 backend dynamic
5105 fullconn 10000
5106 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5107 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5108
5109 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5110
5111
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005112grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005113 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005115 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005116 Arguments :
5117 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5118 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5119 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5120
5121 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5122 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005123 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005124 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5125
5126 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5127 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5128 simplify it.
5129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005130
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005131hash-balance-factor <factor>
5132 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5134 yes | no | no | yes
5135 Arguments :
5136 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5137 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005138 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005139
5140 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5141 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5142 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5143 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5144 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5145 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5146 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5147
5148 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5149 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5150 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5151 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5152 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5153
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005154 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5155 consistent hashing mechanism.
5156
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005157 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5158
5159
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005160hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005161 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5163 yes | no | yes | yes
5164 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005165 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5166 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005167
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005168 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5169 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5170 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5171 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5172 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5173 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5174 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5175 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5176 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5177 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005178
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005179 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5180 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5181 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5182 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5183 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5184 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5185 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5186 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5187 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5188 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5189 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5190 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5191 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005192 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5193 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005194
5195 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5196
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005197 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005198 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5199 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5200 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005201 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5202 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5203 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005204
5205 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5206 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005207 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5208 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5209 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5210 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5211
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005212 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005213 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5214 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5215 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5216 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5217 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5218 parameter.
5219
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005220 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5221 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5222 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5223 used on strings.
5224
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005225 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5226
5227 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5228 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5229 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5230 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5231 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5232 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5233 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5234 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5235 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5236 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5237 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5238 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005239
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005240 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5241 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5242 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005243
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005244 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005245
5246
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005247http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5248 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5249 ones).
5250
5251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5252 no | yes | yes | yes
5253
5254 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5255 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5256 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5257 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5258 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5259 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5260
5261 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5262 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5263 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5264
5265 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5266 below.
5267
5268 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5269 instance.
5270
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005271 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5272 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5273 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5274
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005275 Example:
5276 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5277 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5278 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5279
5280http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5281
5282 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5283 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5284 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5285 example, or to pass some internal information.
5286 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5287 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5288 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5289
5290http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5291
5292 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5293 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5294
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005295http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005296
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005297 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5298 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5299 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5300 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5301 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005302
5303http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5304 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5305
5306 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5307
5308 Example:
5309 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5310
5311 # applied to:
5312 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5313
5314 # outputs:
5315 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5316
5317 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5318
5319http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5320 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5321
5322 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5323
5324 Example:
5325 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5326
5327 # applied to:
5328 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5329
5330 # outputs:
5331 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5332
5333http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5334
5335 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5336 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5337 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5338
5339http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5340 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5341
5342 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5343 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5344 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5345 fallback.
5346
5347 Example:
5348 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5349 http-response set-status 431
5350 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5351 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5352
5353http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5354
5355 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5356 inline.
5357
5358 Arguments:
5359 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5360 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5361 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5362 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5363 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5364 (request and response)
5365 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5366 processing
5367 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5368 processing
5369 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5370 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5371 and '_'.
5372
5373 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5374 followed by some converters.
5375
5376 Example:
5377 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5378
5379http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5380
5381 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5382 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5383 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5384 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5385 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005386 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005387 processing.
5388
5389 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5390 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005391 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005392 rules evaluation.
5393
5394http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5395
5396 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5397 details about <var-name>.
5398
5399 Example:
5400 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5401
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005402
5403http-check comment <string>
5404 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5405 it fails.
5406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5407 yes | no | yes | yes
5408
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005409 Arguments :
5410 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5411 rule fails.
5412
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005413 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5414 user-friendly error reporting.
5415
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005416 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005417 "http-check expect".
5418
5419
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005420http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5421 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005422 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005423 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5425 yes | no | yes | yes
5426
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005427 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005428 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5429
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005430 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005431 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005432
5433 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5434 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5435 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5436 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5437
5438 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5439
5440 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5441
5442 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5443
5444 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5445
5446 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5447
5448 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5449 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5450 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5451 is used.
5452
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005453 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5454 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5455 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5456 haproxy -vv.
5457
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005458 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5459
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005460 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5461 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5462 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5463 different ports or with different servers.
5464
5465 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5466 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5467 the port with a "http-check connect".
5468
5469 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5470 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5471 do.
5472
5473 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5474 unset-var or comment rules.
5475
5476 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005477 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5478 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5479 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5480 option httpchk
5481
5482 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005483 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005484 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005485 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005486 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005487 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005488
5489 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5490
5491 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005492
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005493
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005494http-check disable-on-404
5495 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005497 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005498 Arguments : none
5499
5500 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5501 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5502 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5503 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5504 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5505 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5506 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5507 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005508 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5509 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005510 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5511 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5512 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005513
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005514 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005515
5516
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005517http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005518 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5519 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5520 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005521 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005523 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005524
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005525 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005526 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5527
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005528 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5529 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5530 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5531 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5532 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5533 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5534 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5535 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5536 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5537 result is always conclusive.
5538
5539 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5540 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5541 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005542 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5543 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005544 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5545 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005546 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5547 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5548 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005549
5550 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5551 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005552 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5553 supported :
5554 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5555 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005556 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5557 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5558 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5559 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5560 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005561
5562 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5563 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005564 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5565 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5566 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5567 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005568 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5569
5570 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5571 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5572 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5573 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5574
5575 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5576 informational message reported in logs if an error
5577 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5578 log-format string.
5579
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005580 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005581 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5582 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005583 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5584 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5585 details on the supported keywords.
5586
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005587 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5588 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5589 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5590 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005591
5592 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5593 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5594 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5595 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5596 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5597
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005598 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5599 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5600 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5601 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5602 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5603 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5604 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005605
5606 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005607 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005608 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5609 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5610 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5611 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5612
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005613 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5614 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005615 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5616 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5617 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5618 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5619 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5620 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5621 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5622 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005623 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5624 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5625 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5626 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5627 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5628 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5629 insensitive on the header names.
5630
5631 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5632 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5633 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5634 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5635 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5636 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005637
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005638 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005639 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005640 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5641 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5642 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5643 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5644 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005645 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005646 trace).
5647
5648 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005649 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005650 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5651 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5652 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5653 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5654 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005655 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005656
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005657 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5658 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5659 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5660 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5661 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5662 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5663
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005664 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005665 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005666 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5667 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5668 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5669 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5670 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5671 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5672
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005673 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5674 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5675 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5676 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5677 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005678
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005679 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5680 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5681
5682 Examples :
5683 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005684 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005685
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005686 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5687 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5688
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005689 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005690 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005691
5692 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005693 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005694
5695 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005696 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005697
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005698 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005699 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005700
5701
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005702http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005703 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5704 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005705 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5706 health checks.
5707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5708 yes | no | yes | yes
5709 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005710 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5711
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005712 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5713 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5714 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5715 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5716 to invent non-standard ones.
5717
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005718 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5719 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5720 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5721 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5722
5723 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5724 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5725 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5726 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005727
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005728 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005729 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005730 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005731 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5732 to add it.
5733
5734 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5735 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5736 to the log-format rules.
5737
5738 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5739 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5740 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005741
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005742 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5743 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5744 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5745 request.
5746
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005747 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5748 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5749 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005750 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5751 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5752 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5753 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005754 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005755
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005756 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005757 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5758 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005759
5760 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5761 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5762 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5763 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5764 configured request authority.
5765
5766 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5767 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005768
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005769 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005770
5771
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005772http-check send-state
5773 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5775 yes | no | yes | yes
5776 Arguments : none
5777
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005778 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005779 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005780 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5781 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5782 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005783
5784 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5785 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5786 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5787 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5788 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005789 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5790 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5791 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5792
5793 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5794 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5795 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5796
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005797 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5798 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5799 checked in multiple backends.
5800
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005801 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005802 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5803
5804 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5805 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5806 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5807 one fails.
5808
5809 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5810 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5811 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5812
5813 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5814 server's queue.
5815
5816 Example of a header received by the application server :
5817 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5818 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5819
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005820 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5821 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005822
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005823
5824http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005825 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5827 yes | no | yes | yes
5828
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005829 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005830 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5831 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5832 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5833 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5834 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5835 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5836 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5837 and '-'.
5838
5839 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5840
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005841 Examples :
5842 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005843
5844
5845http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005846 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005847 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5848 yes | no | yes | yes
5849
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005850 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005851 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5852 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5853 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5854 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5855 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5856 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5857 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5858 and '-'.
5859
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005860 Examples :
5861 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005862
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005863
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005864http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5865 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5866 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5867 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5868 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5870 yes | yes | yes | yes
5871 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005872 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005873 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005874 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005875 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005876
5877 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5878 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5879 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5880 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5881
5882 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5883 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5884 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5885 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5886
5887 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5888 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5889 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5890 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5891 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5892 chroot is performed.
5893
5894 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5895 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5896 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5897 considered.
5898
5899 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5900 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5901 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5902 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5903 considered as a raw string.
5904
5905 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5906 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5907 "content-type".
5908
5909 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5910 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5911 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5912 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5913 evaluated as a log-format string.
5914
5915 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5916 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5917 argument to "content-type".
5918
5919 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5920 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5921 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5922 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5923
5924 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5925 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5926 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5927 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5928 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5929 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5930 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5931 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5932
5933 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5934 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5935 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5936
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005937 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5938 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5939 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5940 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5941 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5942
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005943 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5944 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5945
5946
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005947http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005948 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5949
5950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5951 no | yes | yes | yes
5952
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005953 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5954 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5955 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5956 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5957 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005958
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005959 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5960 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005961
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005962 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005963
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005964 Example:
5965 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5966 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5967 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005968
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005969 http-request allow if nagios
5970 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5971 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5972 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005973
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005974 Example:
5975 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5976 acl add path /addacl
5977 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005978
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005979 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005980
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005981 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5982 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005983
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005984 Example:
5985 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5986 acl setmap path /setmap
5987 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005988
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005989 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005990
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005991 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5992 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005993
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005994 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5995 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005996
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005997http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005998
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005999 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6000 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6001 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6002 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6003 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6004 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6005 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6006 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006008http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006009
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006010 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6011 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6012 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6013 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6014 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6015 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6016 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6017 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006019http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006021 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6022 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006023
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006025http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006026
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006027 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6028 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6029 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6030 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6031 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006032
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006033 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6034 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6035 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6036 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6037 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6038 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6039 instead.
6040
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006041 Example:
6042 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6043 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006044
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006045http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006046
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006047 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006049http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6050 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006052 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6053 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6054 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6055 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6056 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6057 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6058 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6059 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6060 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006062 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6063 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6064 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006065 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6066
6067 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6068 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6069 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6070 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006072http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006073
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006074 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6075 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6076 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6077 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6078 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6079 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006080
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006081http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006082
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006083 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6084 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6085 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6086 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6087 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006088
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006089http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006091 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6092 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6093 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6094 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6095 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6096 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006097
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006098http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6099http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6100 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6101 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6102 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6103 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006104
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006105 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6106 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6107 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006108 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006109 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6110 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6111 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006112 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006113 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006114
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006115http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6116 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6117 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6118 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6119
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006120http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6121
6122 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6123 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6124 pointed by <resolvers>.
6125 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6126 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6127 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6128 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6129 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6130 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6131 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6132 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6133 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6134 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6135 to 0.0.0.0.
6136
6137 Example:
6138 resolvers mydns
6139 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6140 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6141 timeout retry 1s
6142 hold valid 10s
6143 hold nx 3s
6144 hold other 3s
6145 hold obsolete 0s
6146 accepted_payload_size 8192
6147
6148 frontend fe
6149 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6150 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6151 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6152
6153 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6154 # which mean DNS resolution error
6155 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6156
6157 default_backend be
6158
6159 backend b_503
6160 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6161 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6162 # 503 error page to end users
6163
6164 backend be
6165 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6166 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6167 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6168 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6169 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6170
6171 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6172 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6173
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006174http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6175
6176 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6177 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6178 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6179 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006180 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6181 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006182
6183 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6184
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006185http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006186http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006187http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006188http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006189http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006190http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006191http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006192http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6193http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006194
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006195 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6196
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006197 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006198 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6199 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6200 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6201 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006202
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006203 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6204 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6205 the supported backend.
6206
6207 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6208 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6209 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6210 number of segments in the path.
6211
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006212 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6213 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6214 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6215 when improperly combined.
6216
6217 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6218 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6219 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6220 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6221 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6222
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006223 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006224
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006225 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6226
6227 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6228 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6229
6230 Example:
6231 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6232
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006233 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6234
6235 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6236 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6237
6238 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6239 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6240
6241 Example:
6242 - /#foo -> /
6243
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006244 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6245 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006246
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006247 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6248 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6249
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006250 Example:
6251 - /. -> /
6252 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6253 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6254 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006255
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006256 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6257 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6258
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006259 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006260 their preceding segment.
6261
6262 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6263 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6264
6265 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6266 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006267
6268 Example:
6269 - /foo/../ -> /
6270 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6271 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6272 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006273 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006274 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006275 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006276
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006277 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6278 removed as well:
6279
6280 Example:
6281 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6282 - /bar/../../ -> /
6283
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006284 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6285 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006286
6287 Example:
6288 - // -> /
6289 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6290
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006291 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6292 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6293
6294 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6295 ".", "_", and "~".
6296
6297 Example:
6298 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6299 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6300 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6301 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6302
6303 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6304 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6305
6306 Example:
6307 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6308 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6309
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006310 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006311 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006312
6313 Example:
6314 - /%6f -> /%6F
6315 - /%zz -> /%zz
6316
6317 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6318 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6319
6320 Example:
6321 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6322
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006323 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006324 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6325 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6326
6327 Example:
6328 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6329 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6330 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6331
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006332http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006334 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6335 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6336 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6337 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6338 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006340http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006342 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6343 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6344 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6345 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006347http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6348 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006349
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006350 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006351 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6352 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6353 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6354 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6355 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006356
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006357 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6358 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6359 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6360 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6361 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006362
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006363 Example:
6364 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6365
6366 # applied to:
6367 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6368
6369 # outputs:
6370 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6371
6372 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006373
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006374 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6375
6376 # applied to:
6377 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006378
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006379 # outputs:
6380 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006381
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006382http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6383 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6384
6385 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6386 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006387 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6388 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6389 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006390
6391 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6392 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6393 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6394
6395 Example:
6396 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6397 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6398
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006399 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6400 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6401 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6402 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6403
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006404http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6405 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6406
6407 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6408 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6409 query-string are replaced.
6410
6411 Example:
6412 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6413 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6414
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006415http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6416 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6417
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006418 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6419 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6420 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6421 against.
6422
6423 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6424 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6425 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006426
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006427 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6428 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6429 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6430 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6431 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6432 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6433 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6434 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6435 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006436 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6437 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006438
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006439 Example:
6440 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6441 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006442
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006443 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6444 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006446http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6447 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006448
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006449 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6450 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6451 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6452 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006453
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006454 Example:
6455 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006456
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006457 # applied to:
6458 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006459
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006460 # outputs:
6461 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006462
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006463http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6464 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6465 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006466 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006467 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6468
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006469 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006470 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6471 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006472 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006473 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006474 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006475 are followed to create the response :
6476
6477 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6478 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6479 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6480 ignored.
6481
6482 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6483 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006484 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006485 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6486 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006487
6488 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6489 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6490 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006491 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006492 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006493
6494 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6495 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6496 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006497 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006498 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006499 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006500
6501 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6502 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6503 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6504 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6505 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6506 as a raw content.
6507
6508 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6509 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6510 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6511 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6512 considered as a raw string.
6513
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006514 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006515 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6516 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6517 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6518
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006519 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6520 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006521 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006522
6523 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6524
6525 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006526 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006527 if { path /ping }
6528
6529 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6530 if { path /favicon.ico }
6531
6532 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6533 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6534 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006536http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6537http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006538
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006539 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6540 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6541 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006542
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006543http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6544 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006545
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006546 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6547 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6548 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6549 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006550
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006551http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006552
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006553 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6554 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6555 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6556 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6557 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006558
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006559 Arguments:
6560 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6561 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006563 Example:
6564 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6565 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006567 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6568 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006569
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006570http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006572 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6573 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6574 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006576 Arguments:
6577 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6578 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006580 Example:
6581 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6582 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006584 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6585 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6586 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006588http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006590 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6591 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6592 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6593 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6594 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006596 Example:
6597 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6598 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6599 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6600 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6601 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6602 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6603 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6604 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6605 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006607http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006609 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6610 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6611 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6612 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6613 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006615http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6616 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006618 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6619 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6620 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6621 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6622 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6623 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6624 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6625 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6626 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006628http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006630 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6631 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6632 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6633 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6634 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6635 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6636 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006638http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006640 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6641 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6642 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006644http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006646 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6647 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6648 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6649 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6650 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6651 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6652 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6653 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006655http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006657 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6658 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6659 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6660 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6661 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6662 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006664 Example :
6665 # prepend the host name before the path
6666 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006667
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006668http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6669
6670 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6671 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6672 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006674http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006676 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6677 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6678 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6679 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6680 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006682http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006683
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006684 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6685 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6686 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6687 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6688 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6689 values have higher priority.
6690 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6691 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6692 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6693 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6694 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006695
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006696http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006698 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6699 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6700 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6701 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6702 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6703 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6704 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006706 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006707
6708 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006709 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6710 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006712http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6713 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6714 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6715 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006716 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6717 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006718
6719 Arguments :
6720 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6721 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006722
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006723 See also "option forwardfor".
6724
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006725 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006726 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6727 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6728
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006729 # After the masking this will track connections
6730 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6731 http-request track-sc0 src
6732
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006733 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6734 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6735
6736http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6737
6738 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6739 expression.
6740
6741 Arguments:
6742 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6743 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006744
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006745 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006746 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6747 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6748
6749 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6750 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6751 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6752
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006753http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006754 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6755
6756 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6757 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6758 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6759 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6760 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6761
6762 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6763 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6764 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6765 results.
6766
6767 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006768 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6769 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006771http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6772
6773 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6774 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6775 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6776 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6777 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6778 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6779 information from the request.
6780
6781 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6782
6783http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6784
6785 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6786 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6787 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6788 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6789 path and the query string.
6790 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6791
6792http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6793
6794 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6795 inline.
6796
6797 Arguments:
6798 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6799 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6800 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6801 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6802 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6803 (request and response)
6804 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6805 processing
6806 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6807 processing
6808 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6809 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6810 and '_'.
6811
6812 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6813 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006814
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006815 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006816 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006817
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006818http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6819 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006820
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006821 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6822 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6823 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6824 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6825 agent name must be used.
6826
6827 Arguments:
6828 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6829
6830 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6831 configuration.
6832
6833http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6834
6835 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6836 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6837 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6838 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6839 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6840 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6841 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6842 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6843 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6844 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6845 action.
6846 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6847 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6848 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6849 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6850 you fully understand how it works.
6851
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006852http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6853
6854 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6855 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6856 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6857 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6858 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006859 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006860 processing.
6861
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006862 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006863 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6864 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6865 rules evaluation.
6866
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006867http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6868http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6869 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6870 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6871 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6872 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006873
6874 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6875 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6876 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006877 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6878 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6879 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6880 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6881 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6882 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006883 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006884 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6885 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6886 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006887 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006888 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6889 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6890 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6891 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6892 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006893
6894http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6895http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6896http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6897
6898 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6899 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6900 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6901 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006902 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006903 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6904 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6905 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6906 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6907 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6908 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6909 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6910
6911 Arguments :
6912 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6913 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6914 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6915 select which table entry to update the counters.
6916
6917 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6918 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6919 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6920 that table until the session ends.
6921
6922 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6923 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6924 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6925 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6926 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6927 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6928 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6929 useful information.
6930
6931 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6932 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6933 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6934 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6935 checks that make use of it.
6936
6937http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6938
6939 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006940
6941 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006942 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006943
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006944http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6945
6946 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6947 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6948 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6949 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6950 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6951 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6952
6953 Arguments :
6954 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6955
6956 Example:
6957 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6958
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006959http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6960 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6961
6962 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6963 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6964 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6965 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6966 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6967 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6968 http-buffer-request".
6969
6970 Arguments :
6971
6972 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6973 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6974
6975 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006976 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006977 bytes.
6978
6979 Example:
6980 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6981
6982 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6983
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006984http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006985
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006986 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6987 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6988 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006989
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006990
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006991http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006992 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6993
6994 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6995 no | yes | yes | yes
6996
6997 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6998 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6999 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7000 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7001 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7002 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7003
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007004 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7005 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007006
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007007 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007008
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007009 Example:
7010 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007011
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007012 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007013
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007014 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7015 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007016
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007017 Example:
7018 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007019
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007020 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007021
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007022 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7023 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007024
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007025 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7026 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007028http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007029
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007030 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7031 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7032 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7033 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7034 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7035 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7036 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7037 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007039http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007041 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7042 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7043 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7044 example, or to pass some internal information.
7045 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7046 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7047 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007049http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007051 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7052 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007053
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007054http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007055
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007056 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007057
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007058http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007059
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007060 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7061 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7062 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7063 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7064 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7065 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7066 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007068 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7069 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7070 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7071 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7072 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007073
7074 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7075 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7076 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7077 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007078
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007079http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007081 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7082 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7083 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7084 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7085 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7086 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007087
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007088http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007089
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007090 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7091 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7092 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7093 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7094 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007096http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007098 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7099 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7100 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7101 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7102 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7103 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007104
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007105http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7106http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7107 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7108 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7109 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7110 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007111
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007112 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7113 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7114 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007115 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007116 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7117 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7118 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007119 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007120 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007121
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007122http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007123
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007124 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7125 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7126 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7127 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7128 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7129 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007130
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007131http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7132 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007133
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007134 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7135 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007136
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007137 Example:
7138 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007139
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007140 # applied to:
7141 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007143 # outputs:
7144 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007145
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007146 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007147
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007148http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7149 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007150
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007151 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007152 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007153
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007154 Example:
7155 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007156
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007157 # applied to:
7158 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007160 # outputs:
7161 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007162
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007163http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7164 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7165 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007166 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007167 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7168
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007169 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007170 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7171 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007172 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007173 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007174 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007175 are followed to create the response :
7176
7177 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7178 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7179 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7180 ignored.
7181
7182 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7183 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007184 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007185 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7186 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007187
7188 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7189 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7190 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007191 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007192 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007193
7194 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7195 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7196 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007197 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007198 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007199 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007200
7201 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7202 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7203 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7204 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7205 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7206 as a raw content.
7207
7208 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7209 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7210 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7211 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7212 considered as a raw string.
7213
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007214 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7215 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7216 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7217 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7218
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007219 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7220 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007221 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007222
7223 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7224
7225 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007226 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007227 if { status eq 404 }
7228
7229 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7230 string "This is the end !" \
7231 if { status eq 500 }
7232
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007233http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7234http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007235
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007236 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7237 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7238 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007239
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007240http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7241 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007242
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007243 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7244 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7245 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7246 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007247
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007248http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7249 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007250
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007251 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7252 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7253 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7254 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7255 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007256
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007257 Arguments:
7258 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007259
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007260 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7261 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007262
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007263http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007264
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007265 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7266 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7267 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007268
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007269http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7270
7271 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7272 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7273 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7274 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7275 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7276
7277http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7278
7279 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7280 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7281 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7282 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7283 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7284 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7285 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7286 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7287 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7288
7289http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7290
7291 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7292 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7293 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7294 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7295 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7296 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7297 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7298
7299http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7300
7301 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7302 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7303 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7304 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7305 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7306 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7307 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7308 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7309
7310http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7311 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7312
7313 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7314 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7315 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7316 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007317
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007318 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007319 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7320 http-response set-status 431
7321 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7322 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007323
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007324http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007325
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007326 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7327 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7328 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7329 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7330 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7331 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7332 based on some information from the request.
7333
7334 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7335
7336http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7337
7338 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7339 inline.
7340
7341 Arguments:
7342 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7343 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7344 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7345 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7346 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7347 (request and response)
7348 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7349 processing
7350 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7351 processing
7352 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7353 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7354 and '_'.
7355
7356 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7357 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007358
7359 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007360 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007361
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007362http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007363
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007364 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7365 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7366 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7367 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7368 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7369 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7370 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7371 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7372 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7373 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7374 action.
7375 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7376 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7377 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7378 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7379 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007380
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007381http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7382
7383 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7384 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7385 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7386 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7387 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007388 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007389 processing.
7390
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007391 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007392 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007393 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007394 rules evaluation.
7395
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007396http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7397http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7398http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007399
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007400 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7401 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7402 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7403 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7404 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007405 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007406
7407http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7408
7409 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7410 about <var-name>.
7411
7412 Example:
7413 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7414
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007415http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7416 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7417
7418 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7419 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7420 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7421 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7422 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7423 buffer is full.
7424
7425 Arguments :
7426
7427 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7428 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7429
7430 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007431 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007432 bytes.
7433
7434 Example:
7435 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007436
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007437http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7438 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7439
7440 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7441 yes | no | yes | yes
7442
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007443 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007444 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7445 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7446 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007447
7448 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7449
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007450 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7451 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7452 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7453 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7454 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7455 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7456 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007457 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007458 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7459 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007460
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007461 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7462 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7463 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7464 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7465 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7466 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7467 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007468 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7469 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7470 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7471 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7472 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7473 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007474
7475 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7476 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7477 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7478 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7479 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7480 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7481 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7482 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007483 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007484 downsides of rare connection failures.
7485
7486 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7487 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7488 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7489 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7490 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7491 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007492 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007493 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7494 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7495 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7496 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7497 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7498
7499 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007500 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7501 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7502 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7503 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007504
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007505 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7506 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007507
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007508 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007509
7510 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7511 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7512 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7513
7514 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7515
7516
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007517http-send-name-header [<header>]
7518 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007519 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7520 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007521 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007522 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7523
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007524 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7525 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7526 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7527 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7528 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7529 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7530 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7531 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7532 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7533 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7534 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7535 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7536 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7537 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7538 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7539 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007540
7541 See also : "server"
7542
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007543id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007544 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7546 no | yes | yes | yes
7547 Arguments : none
7548
7549 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7550 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7551 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007552
7553
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007554ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7555 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7556 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007557 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007558
7559 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7560 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7561 and running).
7562
7563 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7564 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7565 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007566 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007567 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7568
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007569 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7570 "unless" condition is met.
7571
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007572 Example:
7573 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7574 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7575 ignore-persist if url_static
7576
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007577 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7578
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007579load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7580 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7581 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7582 yes | no | yes | yes
7583
7584 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7585 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7586 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007587 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007588 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007589 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7590 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7591 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7592
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007593 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007594 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007595 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007596
7597 Arguments:
7598 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7599 named "server-state-file".
7600
7601 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7602 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7603 name is used as a file name.
7604
7605 none don't load any stat for this backend
7606
7607 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007608 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7609 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7610 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007611 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007612 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007613
7614 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7615 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7616
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007617 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007618
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007619 global
7620 stats socket /tmp/socket
7621 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007622
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007623 defaults
7624 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007625
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007626 backend bk
7627 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7628 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007629
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007630
7631 Then one can run :
7632
7633 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7634
7635 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7636
7637 1
7638 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7639 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7640 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7641
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007642 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007643
7644 global
7645 stats socket /tmp/socket
7646 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7647
7648 defaults
7649 load-server-state-from-file local
7650
7651 backend bk
7652 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7653 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7654
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007655
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007656 Then one can run :
7657
7658 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7659
7660 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7661
7662 1
7663 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7664 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7665 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7666
7667 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7668 "show servers state"
7669
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007670
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007671log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007672log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007673 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007674no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007675 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7677 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007678
7679 Prefix :
7680 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7681 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7682 prefix does not allow arguments.
7683
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007684 Arguments :
7685 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7686 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7687 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7688 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7689 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7690 parameter.
7691
7692 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7693 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7694
7695 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7696 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7697 standard syslog port).
7698
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007699 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7700 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7701 standard syslog port).
7702
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007703 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7704 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7705 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007706 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007707
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007708 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7709 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7710 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7711 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7712 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7713 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7714 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7715 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7716 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7717 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7718 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7719 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007720 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007721 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7722 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7723 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007724 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7725 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007726
7727 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7728 and "fd@2", see above.
7729
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007730 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7731 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7732 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7733 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7734 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7735 having the logs instantly available.
7736
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007737 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7738 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7739 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7740
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007741 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7742 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007743
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007744 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7745 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7746 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7747 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7748 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7749 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7750 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7751 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7752 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7753 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007754 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007755
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007756 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7757 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7758 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7759 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7760 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7761
7762 <sample_size>
7763 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7764 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7765 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7766 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7767 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7768
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007769 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7770 one of the following :
7771
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007772 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7773 field is stripped. This is the default.
7774 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7775 rfc3164.
7776
7777 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007778 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7779
7780 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7781 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7782
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007783 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7784 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7785 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7786 designed to be used with a local log server.
7787
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007788 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7789 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7790 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7791 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7792 systemd logger consumes.
7793
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007794 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7795 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7796 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7797 used with a local log server.
7798
7799 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7800 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7801 designed to be used with a local log server.
7802
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007803 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7804 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7805 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7806 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7807
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007808 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7809
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007810 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7811 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7812 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7813
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007814 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7815 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7816 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7817 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007818
7819 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7820 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7821 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007822 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7823 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7824 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7825 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7826 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007827
7828 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7829
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007830 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7831 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7832 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007833
7834 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7835 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7836 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7837 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7838
7839 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7840 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007841
7842 Example :
7843 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007844 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7845 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7846 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007847 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007848 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7849 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007850 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007851
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007852
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007853log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007854 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7856 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007857
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007858 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7859 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7860 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7861 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7862 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007863
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007864 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7865 "option httplog" directives.
7866
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007867log-format-sd <string>
7868 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7869 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7870 yes | yes | yes | no
7871
7872 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7873 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7874 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7875 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7876 which covers the log format string in depth.
7877
7878 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7879 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7880
7881 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7882 log format to "rfc5424".
7883
7884 Example :
7885 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7886
7887
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007888log-tag <string>
7889 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7890 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7891 yes | yes | yes | yes
7892
7893 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7894 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007895 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007896 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7897 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7898 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7899 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7900 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7901 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007902
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007903max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7904 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7905 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7906 yes | no | yes | yes
7907
7908 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7909 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7910 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7911 servers.
7912
7913 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007914 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007915 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7916 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7917 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007918 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007919 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7920 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7921 picking a different server.
7922
7923 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7924 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7925 even if they have to be queued.
7926
7927 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7928 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7929
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007930max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7931 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7932 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7933 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007934
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007935maxconn <conns>
7936 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7938 yes | yes | yes | no
7939 Arguments :
7940 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7941 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7942 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7943 closes.
7944
7945 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007946 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007947 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7948 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007949 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7950 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7951 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7952 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007953
7954 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7955 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7956 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7957
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007958 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7959 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007960
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007961 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7962
7963
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007964mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007965 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7967 yes | yes | yes | yes
7968 Arguments :
7969 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7970 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7971 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7972 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7973
7974 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7975 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7976 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7977 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7978 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7979
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007980 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7981 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7982 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007983
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007984 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007985 defaults http_instances
7986 mode http
7987
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007988
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007989monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007990 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7992 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007993 Arguments :
7994 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7995 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007996 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007997 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7998 backend and its backup.
7999
8000 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8001 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8002 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8003 servers in a list of backends.
8004
8005 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8006 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8007 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008008 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008009 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8010 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008011 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008012 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8013 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008014
8015 Example:
8016 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008017 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008018 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8019 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8020 monitor-uri /site_alive
8021 monitor fail if site_dead
8022
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008023 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008024
8025
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008026monitor-uri <uri>
8027 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8029 yes | yes | yes | no
8030 Arguments :
8031 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8032 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8033
8034 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8035 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8036 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8037 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8038 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8039 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8040 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8041 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8042
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008043 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008044 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8045 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8046 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8047 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8048 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8049 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008050
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008051 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8052 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8053 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8054 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8055
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008056 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008057 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008058 frontend www
8059 mode http
8060 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8061
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008062 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008063
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008064
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008065option abortonclose
8066no option abortonclose
8067 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8069 yes | no | yes | yes
8070 Arguments : none
8071
8072 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8073 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8074 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8075 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008076 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008077 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8078 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8079 encountered while delivering the response.
8080
8081 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8082 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8083 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8084 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8085 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8086 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008087 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008088 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008089 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008090 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8091 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8092 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8093
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008094 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8095 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008096 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8097 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8098 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8099 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8100 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8101 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008102 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008103
8104 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8105 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8106
8107 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8108
8109
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008110option accept-invalid-http-request
8111no option accept-invalid-http-request
8112 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8114 yes | yes | yes | no
8115 Arguments : none
8116
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008117 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008118 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008119 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008120 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8121 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8122 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8123 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8124 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008125 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8126 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8127 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8128 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008129 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008130 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008131 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8132 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8133 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008134
8135 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8136 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8137 been confirmed.
8138
8139 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8140 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008141 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8142 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008143 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8144
8145 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8146 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8147
8148 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8149 stats socket.
8150
8151
8152option accept-invalid-http-response
8153no option accept-invalid-http-response
8154 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8156 yes | no | yes | yes
8157 Arguments : none
8158
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008159 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008160 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008161 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008162 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8163 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8164 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8165 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8166 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008167 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8168 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8169 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008170
8171 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8172 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8173 been confirmed.
8174
8175 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8176 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8177 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8178 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8179
8180 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8181 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8182
8183 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8184 stats socket.
8185
8186
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008187option allbackups
8188no option allbackups
8189 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8191 yes | no | yes | yes
8192 Arguments : none
8193
8194 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8195 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8196 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8197 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8198 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8199 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8200 order between the backup servers anymore.
8201
8202 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8203 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8204
8205 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8206 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8207
8208
8209option checkcache
8210no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008211 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8213 yes | no | yes | yes
8214 Arguments : none
8215
8216 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8217 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008218 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008219 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8220 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008221 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008222
8223 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008224 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008225 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008226 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8227 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008228 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008229 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008230 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8231 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008232 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008233 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8234 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008235 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008236 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8237 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8238 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8239 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8240 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8241 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8242 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8243 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8244 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8245
8246 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008247 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8248 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8249 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8250 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008251
8252 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8253 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008254 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008255 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008256
8257 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8258 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8259
8260
8261option clitcpka
8262no option clitcpka
8263 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8265 yes | yes | yes | no
8266 Arguments : none
8267
8268 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8269 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008270 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008271 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8272
8273 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8274 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8275 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8276 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8277
8278 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8279 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8280 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8281 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8282 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8283
8284 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8285
8286 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8287 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8288 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8289
8290 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8291 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8292
8293 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8294
8295
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008296option contstats
8297 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8299 yes | yes | yes | no
8300 Arguments : none
8301
8302 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8303 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8304 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008305 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008306 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8307 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8308 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8309 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8310 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008311
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008312option disable-h2-upgrade
8313no option disable-h2-upgrade
8314 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8315 connection.
8316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8317 yes | yes | yes | no
8318 Arguments : none
8319
8320 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8321 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8322 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8323 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008324 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8325 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8326 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8327 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8328 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8329 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008330
8331 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8332 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008333
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008334option dontlog-normal
8335no option dontlog-normal
8336 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8338 yes | yes | yes | no
8339 Arguments : none
8340
8341 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8342 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8343 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8344 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8345 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8346 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8347 logged.
8348
8349 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8350 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8351 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008353 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008354 logging.
8355
8356
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008357option dontlognull
8358no option dontlognull
8359 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8361 yes | yes | yes | no
8362 Arguments : none
8363
8364 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8365 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8366 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8367 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8368 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8369 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008370 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8371 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8372 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008373
8374 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008375 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008376 would not be logged.
8377
8378 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8379 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8380
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008381 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008382 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008383
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008384
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008385option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008386 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8388 yes | yes | yes | yes
8389 Arguments :
8390 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8391 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008392 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008393 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008394
8395 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8396 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8397 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8398 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8399 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8400 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8401 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008402 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8403 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8404 possible that the client has already brought one.
8405
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008406 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008407 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008408 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008409 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008410 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008411 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008412
8413 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8414 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8415 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8416 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8417 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8418 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008419 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008420
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008421 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8422 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008423 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008424 are under the control of the end-user.
8425
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008426 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008427 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8428 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008429 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8430 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8431 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008432
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008433 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008434 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8435 frontend www
8436 mode http
8437 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8438
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008439 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8440 backend www
8441 mode http
8442 option forwardfor header X-Client
8443
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008444 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008445 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008446
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008447
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008448option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8449no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8450 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8452 yes | yes | yes | no
8453 Arguments : none
8454
8455 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8456 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8457 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8458 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8459 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8460 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8461 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8462
8463 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8464 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8465 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8466 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8467 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8468 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8469 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8470 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8471 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8472 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8473
8474 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8475
8476 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8477 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8478
8479 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8480 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8481
8482
8483option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8484no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8485 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8487 yes | no | yes | yes
8488 Arguments : none
8489
8490 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8491 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8492 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8493 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8494 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8495 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8496 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8497
8498 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8499 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8500 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8501 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8502 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8503 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8504 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8505 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8506 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8507 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8508
8509 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8510
8511 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8512 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8513
8514 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8515 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8516
8517
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008518option http-buffer-request
8519no option http-buffer-request
8520 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8522 yes | yes | yes | yes
8523 Arguments : none
8524
8525 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8526 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8527 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8528 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8529 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8530 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008531 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8532 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8533 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8534 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008535
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008536 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8537 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008538
8539
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008540option http-ignore-probes
8541no option http-ignore-probes
8542 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8544 yes | yes | yes | no
8545 Arguments : none
8546
8547 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8548 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8549 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8550 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8551 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8552 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8553 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8554 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8555 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008556 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8557 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008558 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8559
8560 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8561 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8562 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8563 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8564 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8565 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8566 are often the only way to detect them.
8567
8568 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8569 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8570
8571 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8572
8573
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008574option http-keep-alive
8575no option http-keep-alive
8576 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8578 yes | yes | yes | yes
8579 Arguments : none
8580
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008581 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8582 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008583 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8584 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008585 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8586 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8587 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008588
8589 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8590 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008591 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8592 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8593 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8594 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8595 situations where this option may be useful :
8596
8597 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008598 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008599
8600 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8601 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8602
8603 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8604 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8605 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8606 request.
8607
8608 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8609 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008610 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8611 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8612 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008613
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008614 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8615 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8616 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8617 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8618 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8619 not set.
8620
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008621 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8622 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8623 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008624
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008625 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008626 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008627 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008628
8629
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008630option http-no-delay
8631no option http-no-delay
8632 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8634 yes | yes | yes | yes
8635 Arguments : none
8636
8637 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8638 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8639 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8640 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8641 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8642 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8643 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008644 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008645 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8646 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8647 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8648 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8649 affected.
8650
8651 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8652 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8653 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8654 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8655 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8656 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8657 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8658 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8659 latency environments.
8660
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008661 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8662
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008663
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008664option http-pretend-keepalive
8665no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008666 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008668 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008669 Arguments : none
8670
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008671 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008672 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8673 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8674 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008675 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008676 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8677 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8678 consider the response complete.
8679
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008680 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008681 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008682 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008683 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008684 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008685 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8686
8687 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8688 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8689 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8690 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008691 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8692 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008693 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8694
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008695 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8696 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8697 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8698 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8699 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8700 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008701
8702 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8703 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8704
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008705 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008706 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008707
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008708
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008709option http-server-close
8710no option http-server-close
8711 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8713 yes | yes | yes | yes
8714 Arguments : none
8715
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008716 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8717 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8718 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8719 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008720 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8721 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8722 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8723 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8724 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8725 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8726 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8727 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8728 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8729 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8730 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008731
8732 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8733 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8734 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8735 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008736 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8737 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008738
8739 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8740 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008741 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8742 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8743 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008744
8745 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8746 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8747
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008748 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8749 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008750
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008751option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008752no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008753 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8755 yes | yes | yes | no
8756 Arguments : none
8757
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008758 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008759 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8760 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8761 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8762 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8763 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008764 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008765
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008766 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008767 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008768 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8769 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8770 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008771
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008772 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8773 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8774 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8775 front of an existing proxy.
8776
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008777 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8778
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008779 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008780
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008781option httpchk
8782option httpchk <uri>
8783option httpchk <method> <uri>
8784option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008785 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8787 yes | no | yes | yes
8788 Arguments :
8789 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8790 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8791 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8792 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8793 ones.
8794
8795 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8796 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8797 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8798
8799 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8800 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8801 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008802 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008803
8804 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8805 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8806 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8807 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8808 the lack of any response.
8809
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008810 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8811 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8812 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8813 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8814
8815 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8816 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8817 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008818
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008819 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8820 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008821 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008822 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008823 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008824
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008825 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8826 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8827 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8828 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8829
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008830 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008831 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8832 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8833 backend https_relay
8834 mode tcp
8835 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8836 http-check send hdr Host www
8837 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008838
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008839 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8840 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8841 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008842
8843
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008844option httpclose
8845no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008846 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8848 yes | yes | yes | yes
8849 Arguments : none
8850
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008851 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8852 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8853 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8854 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008855 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008856
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008857 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8858 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008859 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008860 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8861 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008862
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008863 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8864 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8865 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008866
8867 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8868 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008869 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8870 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8871 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008872
8873 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8874 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8875
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008876 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008877
8878
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008879option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008880 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008882 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008883 Arguments :
8884 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8885 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8886 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008887 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008888 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008889
8890 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8891 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8892 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8893 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8894 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8895 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8896 ports.
8897
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008898 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8899 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008900
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008901 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008903 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008904
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008905
8906option http_proxy
8907no option http_proxy
8908 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8910 yes | yes | yes | yes
8911 Arguments : none
8912
8913 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8914 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8915 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8916 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8917 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8918
8919 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8920 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008921 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8922 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008923
8924 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8925 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8926
8927 Example :
8928 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8929 backend direct_forward
8930 option httpclose
8931 option http_proxy
8932
8933 See also : "option httpclose"
8934
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008935
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008936option independent-streams
8937no option independent-streams
8938 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8940 yes | yes | yes | yes
8941 Arguments : none
8942
8943 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8944 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8945 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8946 receive data or not.
8947
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008948 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008949 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8950 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8951 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8952 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8953 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8954 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8955 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8956 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8957 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8958 socket buffers.
8959
8960 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8961 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8962 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8963 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8964 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8965
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008966 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008967
8968
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008969option ldap-check
8970 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8972 yes | no | yes | yes
8973 Arguments : none
8974
8975 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8976 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8977 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8978 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8979
8980 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8981 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8982
8983 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8984 configure it.
8985
8986 Example :
8987 option ldap-check
8988
8989 See also : "option httpchk"
8990
8991
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008992option external-check
8993 Use external processes for server health checks
8994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8995 yes | no | yes | yes
8996
8997 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8998 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8999 command".
9000
9001 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9002
9003 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9004
9005
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009006option log-health-checks
9007no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009008 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9010 yes | no | yes | yes
9011 Arguments : none
9012
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009013 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9014 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9015 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009016
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009017 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9018 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9019 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9020 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9021 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9022
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009023 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009024 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009025
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009026 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9027 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9028 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009029
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009030
9031option log-separate-errors
9032no option log-separate-errors
9033 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9035 yes | yes | yes | no
9036 Arguments : none
9037
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009038 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009039 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9040 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9041 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9042 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9043 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9044 provides very important information.
9045
9046 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9047 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9048 error logs.
9049
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009050 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009051 logging.
9052
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009053
9054option logasap
9055no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009056 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9058 yes | yes | yes | no
9059 Arguments : none
9060
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009061 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9062 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9063 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9064 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9065
9066 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9067 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9068 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9069 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9070 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009071 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009072 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9073 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9074 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9075 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009076 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009077
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009078 Examples :
9079 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9080 mode http
9081 option httplog
9082 option logasap
9083 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9084
9085 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9086 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9087 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9088 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009090 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009091 logging.
9092
9093
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009094option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009095 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9097 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009098 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009099 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9100 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009101 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9102 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009103
9104 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9105 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009106 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009107 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009108 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9109 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9110 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009111
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009112 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9113 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9114 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009115
9116 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009117 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009118 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9119 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9120 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9121 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9122 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9123 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9124 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9125
9126 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9127 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009128
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009129 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009130
9131 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9132 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9133 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9134 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009135 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009136 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009137
9138 See also: "option httpchk"
9139
9140
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009141option nolinger
9142no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009143 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009144 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9145 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009146 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009147
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009148 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009149 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9150 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9151 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9152 connections.
9153
9154 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9155 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009156 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9157 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9158 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9159 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9160 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9161 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9162 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9163 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9164 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9165 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9166 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9167 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9168 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009169
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009170 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9171 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9172 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9173 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9174 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009175
9176 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9177 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009178 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009179 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009180 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009181
9182 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9183 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9184
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009185 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9186 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009187
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009188option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9189 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9191 yes | yes | yes | yes
9192 Arguments :
9193 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9194 matching <network>
9195 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9196 header name.
9197
9198 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9199 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9200 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9201 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9202 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9203 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9204 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9205 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9206 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9207 possible that the client has already brought one.
9208
9209 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9210 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9211 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9212 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9213 header and requires different one.
9214
9215 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9216 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9217 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009218 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9219 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9220 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9221 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9222 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009223
9224 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9225 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9226 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9227 both are defined.
9228
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009229 Examples :
9230 # Original Destination address
9231 frontend www
9232 mode http
9233 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9234
9235 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9236 backend www
9237 mode http
9238 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9239
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009240 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009241
9242
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009243option persist
9244no option persist
9245 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9246 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9247 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009248 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009249
9250 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9251 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9252 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9253 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9254 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9255 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9256 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9257 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9258 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9259 redirected to another valid server.
9260
9261 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9262 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9263
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009264 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009265
9266
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009267option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9268 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9270 yes | no | yes | yes
9271 Arguments :
9272 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9273 PostgreSQL server.
9274
9275 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9276 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9277 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9278 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9279
9280 See also: "option httpchk"
9281
9282
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009283option prefer-last-server
9284no option prefer-last-server
9285 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9286 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9287 yes | no | yes | yes
9288 Arguments : none
9289
9290 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009291 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009292 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9293 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009294 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009295 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009296 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009297 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9298 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009299 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009300 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009301 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9302 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9303 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009304 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9305 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9306 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009307
9308 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9309 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9310
9311 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9312
9313
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009314option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009315option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009316no option redispatch
9317 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9318 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9319 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009320 Arguments :
9321 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9322 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9323 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009324 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009325 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009326 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009327 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9328 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9329 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9330
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009331
9332 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9333 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9334 be able to access the service anymore.
9335
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009336 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9337 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009338
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009339 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9340 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9341 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9342 following order:
9343
9344 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9345
9346 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9347 list, or
9348
9349 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9350
9351 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9352 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9353
9354 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9355 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9356 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9357 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9358
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009359 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009360 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9361 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009363 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9364 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9365
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009366 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009367
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009368
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009369option redis-check
9370 Use redis health checks for server testing
9371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9372 yes | no | yes | yes
9373 Arguments : none
9374
9375 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9376 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9377 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9378 find the "+PONG" response message.
9379
9380 Example :
9381 option redis-check
9382
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009383 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009384
9385
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009386option smtpchk
9387option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9388 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9390 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009391 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009392 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009393 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009394 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9395
9396 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9397 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9398 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9399
9400 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9401 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9402 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9403 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9404 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9405 dead server.
9406
9407 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9408 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009409 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009410 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9411
9412 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9413 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9414 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9415 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009416 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009417
9418 Example :
9419 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9420
9421 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009424option socket-stats
9425no option socket-stats
9426
9427 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9429 yes | yes | yes | no
9430
9431 Arguments : none
9432
9433
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009434option splice-auto
9435no option splice-auto
9436 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9438 yes | yes | yes | yes
9439 Arguments : none
9440
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009441 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009442 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009443 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009444 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009445 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009446 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9447 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9448 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9449 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9450
9451 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9452 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9453 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9454 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9455 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9456 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9457 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9458 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9459 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9460 keyword.
9461
9462 Example :
9463 option splice-auto
9464
9465 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9466 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9467
9468 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9469 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9470
9471
9472option splice-request
9473no option splice-request
9474 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9476 yes | yes | yes | yes
9477 Arguments : none
9478
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009479 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009480 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009481 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9482 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9483 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9484 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9485
9486 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9487
9488 Example :
9489 option splice-request
9490
9491 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9492 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9493
9494 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9495 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9496
9497
9498option splice-response
9499no option splice-response
9500 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9502 yes | yes | yes | yes
9503 Arguments : none
9504
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009505 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009506 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009507 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9508 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9509 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9510 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9511
9512 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9513
9514 Example :
9515 option splice-response
9516
9517 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9518 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9519
9520 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9521 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9522
9523
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009524option spop-check
9525 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9527 no | no | no | yes
9528 Arguments : none
9529
9530 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9531 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9532 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9533 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9534
9535 Example :
9536 option spop-check
9537
9538 See also : "option httpchk"
9539
9540
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009541option srvtcpka
9542no option srvtcpka
9543 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9545 yes | no | yes | yes
9546 Arguments : none
9547
9548 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9549 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009550 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009551 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9552
9553 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9554 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9555 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9556 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9557
9558 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9559 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9560 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9561 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9562 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9563
9564 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9565
9566 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9567 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9568 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9569
9570 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9571 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9572
9573 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9574
9575
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009576option ssl-hello-chk
9577 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9579 yes | no | yes | yes
9580 Arguments : none
9581
9582 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9583 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9584 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9585 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9586 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9587 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9588 hello message.
9589
9590 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9591 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9592 messages, which is appreciable.
9593
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009594 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009595 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9596 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009597
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009598 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9599
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009600
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009601option tcp-check
9602 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9603 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9604 yes | no | yes | yes
9605
9606 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9607 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9608
9609 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9610 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9611 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9612
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009613 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009614 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9615 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9616 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9617 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9618 only.
9619
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009620 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009621 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009622 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9623 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9624 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9625
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009626 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009627 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9628 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009629 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009630 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9631 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9632 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9633 the respective protocols.
9634 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009635 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009636
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009637 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009638
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009639 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9640 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9641 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9642 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009643
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009644 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9645 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9646 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009647
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009648
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009649 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009650 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009651 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009652 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009653
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009654 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009655 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009656 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009657
9658 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9659 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009660 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009661 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009662 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009663 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009664 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009665 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009666 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9667 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009668 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009669 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9670 tcp-check expect string +OK
9671
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009672 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009673 (send many headers before analyzing)
9674 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009675 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009676 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9677 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9678 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9679 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009680 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009681
9682
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009683 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009684
9685
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009686option tcp-smart-accept
9687no option tcp-smart-accept
9688 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9690 yes | yes | yes | no
9691 Arguments : none
9692
9693 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9694 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9695 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9696 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9697 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9698 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9699
9700 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9701 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9702 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9703 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9704
9705 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9706 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9707 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009708 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009709
9710 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9711 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9712 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9713
9714 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9715 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9716 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9717
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009718 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9719
9720
9721option tcp-smart-connect
9722no option tcp-smart-connect
9723 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9725 yes | no | yes | yes
9726 Arguments : none
9727
9728 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9729 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9730 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9731 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9732 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9733
9734 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9735 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9736 complex.
9737
9738 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9739 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9740 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9741
9742 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9743 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9744
9745 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9746
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009747
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009748option tcpka
9749 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9751 yes | yes | yes | yes
9752 Arguments : none
9753
9754 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9755 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009756 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009757 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9758
9759 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9760 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9761 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9762 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9763
9764 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9765 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9766 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9767 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9768 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9769
9770 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9771
9772 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9773 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9774 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9775 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9776 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9777 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9778 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9779 backends.
9780
9781 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9782
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009783
9784option tcplog
9785 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009787 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009788 Arguments : none
9789
9790 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9791 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9792 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9793 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9794 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9795 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9796 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9797 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9798
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009799 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009801 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009802
9803
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009804option transparent
9805no option transparent
9806 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009808 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009809 Arguments : none
9810
9811 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9812 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9813 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9814 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9815 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9816 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9817 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9818 appropriate server.
9819
9820 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9821 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9822
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009823 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009824 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009825
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009826
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009827external-check command <command>
9828 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9830 yes | no | yes | yes
9831
9832 Arguments :
9833 <command> is the external command to run
9834
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009835 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9836
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009837 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009838
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009839 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9840 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9841 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9842 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9843 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9844 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009845
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009846 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9847
9848 Environment variables :
9849 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9850 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9851
9852 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9853
9854 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9855
9856 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9857 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9858 for a UNIX socket).
9859
9860 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9861
9862 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9863
9864 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9865
9866 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9867
9868 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9869
9870 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9871 socket).
9872
9873 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9874 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9875
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009876 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9877
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009878 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9879 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9880 failed.
9881
9882 Example :
9883 external-check command /bin/true
9884
9885 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9886
9887
9888external-check path <path>
9889 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9891 yes | no | yes | yes
9892
9893 Arguments :
9894 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9895
9896 The default path is "".
9897
9898 Example :
9899 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9900
9901 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9902 "external-check command"
9903
9904
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009905persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009906persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009907 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9909 yes | no | yes | yes
9910 Arguments :
9911 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009912 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9913 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009914
9915 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9916 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009917 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009918 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9919 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9920 forwarded to this server.
9921
9922 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9923 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9924 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009925 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009926 a single "listen" section.
9927
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009928 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9929 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9930 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9931
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009932 Example :
9933 listen tse-farm
9934 bind :3389
9935 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9936 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9937 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9938 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9939 persist rdp-cookie
9940 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009941 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009942 balance rdp-cookie
9943 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9944 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9945
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009946 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9947 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009948
9949
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009950rate-limit sessions <rate>
9951 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9953 yes | yes | yes | no
9954 Arguments :
9955 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9956 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9957
9958 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9959 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9960 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009961 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009962 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9963 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9964
9965 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9966 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9967 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9968 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9969
9970 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9971 listen smtp
9972 mode tcp
9973 bind :25
9974 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009975 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009976
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009977 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9978 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9979 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009980
9981 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9982
9983
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009984redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9985redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9986redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009987 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9989 no | yes | yes | yes
9990
9991 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009992 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009993
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009994 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009995 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009996 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9997 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9998 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009999
10000 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10001 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10002 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10003 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10004 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010005 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10006 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10007 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10008 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010009
10010 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10011 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10012 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10013 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10014 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10015 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010016 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010017 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010018 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10019 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10020 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010021
10022 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010023 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10024 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10025 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010026 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010027 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10028 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10029 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10030 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010031
10032 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010033 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010034
10035 - "drop-query"
10036 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10037 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10038 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10039 with a location-type redirect.
10040
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010041 - "append-slash"
10042 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10043 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10044 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10045 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10046
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010047 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10048 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10049 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10050 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10051 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10052 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10053 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10054
10055 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10056 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10057 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10058 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10059 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10060 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10061 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010062
10063 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10064 acl clear dst_port 80
10065 acl secure dst_port 8080
10066 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010067 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010068 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010069 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10070
10071 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010072 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10073 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10074 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010075 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010076
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010077 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10078 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10079 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10080
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010081 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010082 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010083
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010084 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010085 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10086 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10087 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010089 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010090
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010091
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010092retries <value>
10093 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10095 yes | no | yes | yes
10096 Arguments :
10097 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10098 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10099 default value is 3.
10100
10101 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10102 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10103 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10104
10105 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010106 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10107 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010108
10109 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10110 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10111
10112 See also : "option redispatch"
10113
10114
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010115retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010116 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10117 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10118 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010119 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10120 yes | no | yes | yes
10121 Arguments :
10122 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10123 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10124 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10125 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10126
10127 none never retry
10128
10129 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10130 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10131
10132 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10133 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10134 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10135 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10136 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10137 processing the request.
10138
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010139 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10140 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10141 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10142 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10143 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10144 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10145 overflow attack for example).
10146
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010147 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10148 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10149 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10150 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10151 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10152 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10153 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10154 amplify denial of service attacks.
10155
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010156 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10157 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10158 considered to be safe to retry.
10159
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010160 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10161 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10162 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10163 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10164 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010165
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010166 all-retryable-errors
10167 retry request for any error that are considered
10168 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10169 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10170 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10171
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010172 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10173 not cumulative.
10174
10175 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10176 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10177 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10178 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10179
10180 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10181 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10182 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10183 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10184 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10185 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10186 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10187 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10188 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10189 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10190 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10191 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10192
10193 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10194 should not use this directive.
10195
10196 The default is "conn-failure".
10197
10198 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10199
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010200server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010201 Declare a server in a backend
10202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10203 no | no | yes | yes
10204 Arguments :
10205 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010206 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010207 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010208
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010209 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10210 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10211 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10212 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010213 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10214 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010215 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010216 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10217 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010218 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10219 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10220 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10221 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10222 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10223 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10224 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010225 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010226 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10227 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10228 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10229 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10230 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10231 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010232 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10233 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010234 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10235 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010236
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010237 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010238 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10239 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10240 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10241 adding this value to the client's port.
10242
10243 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10244 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010245 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010246
10247 Examples :
10248 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10249 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010250 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010251 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10252 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10253 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010254
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010255 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10256 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10257 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10258 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10259 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10260
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010261 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10262 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010263
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010264server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010265 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010266 this backend.
10267 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10268 no | no | yes | yes
10269
10270 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10271 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10272 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10273 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10274 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010275
10276 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10277 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10278
10279 global
10280 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10281
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010282 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010283 load-server-state-from-file
10284
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010285 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010286 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010287
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010288server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10289 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10290 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10292 no | no | yes | yes
10293
10294 Arguments:
10295 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10296
10297 <num | range>
10298 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10299 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10300 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10301 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10302
10303 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10304
10305 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10306
10307 <params*>
10308 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10309 keyword.
10310
10311 Examples:
10312 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10313 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10314 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10315
10316 # or
10317 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10318
10319 # would be equivalent to:
10320 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10321 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10322 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10323
10324
10325
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010326source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010327source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010328source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010329 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10331 yes | no | yes | yes
10332 Arguments :
10333 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10334 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010335
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010336 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010337 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10338 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10339 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10340 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10341 supported prefixes are :
10342 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10343 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10344 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010345 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010346 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10347 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010348
10349 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10350 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010351 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10352 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10353 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010354
10355 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10356 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10357 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10358 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10359 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10360 <addr>.
10361
10362 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10363 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10364 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10365 port.
10366
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010367 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10368 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10369 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10370 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010371 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010372 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10373 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10374 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10375 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10376 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10377 HTTP header.
10378
10379 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10380 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010381 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010382 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10383 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10384 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10385 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10386 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10387 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10388 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10389
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010390 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10391 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10392 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10393 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10394 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10395 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10396
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010397 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10398 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10399 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10400 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10401
10402 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10403 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10404 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10405 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10406 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10407 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10408
10409 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10410 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10411 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10412 there are two methods :
10413
10414 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10415 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10416 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10417 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10418 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10419 of the client ranges may be used.
10420
10421 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10422 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10423 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10424 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10425 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10426 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10427 same session.
10428
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010429 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10430 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10431 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010432 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010433
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010434 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10435
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010436 Examples :
10437 backend private
10438 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10439 source 192.168.1.200
10440
10441 backend transparent_ssl1
10442 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10443 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10444
10445 backend transparent_ssl2
10446 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10447 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10448 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10449
10450 backend transparent_ssl3
10451 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10452 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10453 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10454
10455 backend transparent_smtp
10456 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10457 # with Tproxy version 4.
10458 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10459
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010460 backend transparent_http
10461 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10462 # proxy.
10463 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10464
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010465 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010466 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10467
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010468
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010469srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10470 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10471 the connection on the server side.
10472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10473 yes | no | yes | yes
10474 Arguments :
10475 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10476
10477 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10478 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010479 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10480 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010481
10482 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10483
10484
10485srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10486 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10487 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10488 server side.
10489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10490 yes | no | yes | yes
10491 Arguments :
10492 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10493 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10494 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10495 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10496
10497 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10498 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010499 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10500 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010501
10502 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10503
10504
10505srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10506 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10508 yes | no | yes | yes
10509 Arguments :
10510 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10511 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10512 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10513 document.
10514
10515 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10516 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010517 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10518 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010519
10520 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10521
10522
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010523stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10524 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010526 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010527
10528 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10529 matched.
10530
10531 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10532 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10533
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010534 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10535 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010536 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010537
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010538 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10539 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10540 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10541 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010542
10543 Example :
10544 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10545 backend stats_localhost
10546 stats enable
10547 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10548
10549 Example :
10550 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10551 backend stats_auth
10552 stats enable
10553 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10554 stats admin if TRUE
10555
10556 Example :
10557 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10558 userlist stats-auth
10559 group admin users admin
10560 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10561 group readonly users haproxy
10562 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10563
10564 backend stats_auth
10565 stats enable
10566 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10567 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10568 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10569 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10570
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010571 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10572 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10573 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010574
10575
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010576stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10577 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010579 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010580 Arguments :
10581 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10582
10583 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10584
10585 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10586 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10587 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10588 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10589 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10590 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10591
10592 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10593 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10594 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010595 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010596
10597 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10598 report using "stats scope".
10599
10600 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10601 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10602 unobvious parameters.
10603
10604 Example :
10605 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10606 backend public_www
10607 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10608 stats enable
10609 stats hide-version
10610 stats scope .
10611 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010612 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010613 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10614 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10615
10616 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10617 backend private_monitoring
10618 stats enable
10619 stats uri /admin?stats
10620 stats refresh 5s
10621
10622 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10623
10624
10625stats enable
10626 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010628 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010629 Arguments : none
10630
10631 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10632 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10633 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10634 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10635 - stats auth : no authentication
10636 - stats scope : no restriction
10637
10638 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10639 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10640 unobvious parameters.
10641
10642 Example :
10643 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10644 backend public_www
10645 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10646 stats enable
10647 stats hide-version
10648 stats scope .
10649 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010650 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010651 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10652 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10653
10654 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10655 backend private_monitoring
10656 stats enable
10657 stats uri /admin?stats
10658 stats refresh 5s
10659
10660 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10661
10662
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010663stats hide-version
10664 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010666 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010667 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010668
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010669 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10670 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10671 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10672 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10673 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10674 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010675
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010676 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10677 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10678 unobvious parameters.
10679
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010680 Example :
10681 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10682 backend public_www
10683 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010684 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010685 stats hide-version
10686 stats scope .
10687 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010688 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010689 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10690 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010691
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010692 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10693 backend private_monitoring
10694 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010695 stats uri /admin?stats
10696 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010697
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010698 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010699
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010700
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010701stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10702 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10703 Access control for statistics
10704
10705 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10706 no | no | yes | yes
10707
10708 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10709 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10710 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10711 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10712 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10713 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10714
10715 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10716 instance.
10717
10718 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10719 about ACL usage.
10720
10721
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010722stats realm <realm>
10723 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010725 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010726 Arguments :
10727 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10728 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10729 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10730
10731 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10732 using a backslash ('\').
10733
10734 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10735 only related to authentication.
10736
10737 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10738 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10739 unobvious parameters.
10740
10741 Example :
10742 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10743 backend public_www
10744 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10745 stats enable
10746 stats hide-version
10747 stats scope .
10748 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010749 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010750 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10751 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10752
10753 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10754 backend private_monitoring
10755 stats enable
10756 stats uri /admin?stats
10757 stats refresh 5s
10758
10759 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10760
10761
10762stats refresh <delay>
10763 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010765 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010766 Arguments :
10767 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10768 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10769 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10770 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10771 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10772 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10773
10774 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10775 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10776 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010777 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010778
10779 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10780 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10781 unobvious parameters.
10782
10783 Example :
10784 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10785 backend public_www
10786 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10787 stats enable
10788 stats hide-version
10789 stats scope .
10790 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010791 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010792 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10793 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10794
10795 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10796 backend private_monitoring
10797 stats enable
10798 stats uri /admin?stats
10799 stats refresh 5s
10800
10801 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10802
10803
10804stats scope { <name> | "." }
10805 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010807 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010808 Arguments :
10809 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10810 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10811 section in which the statement appears.
10812
10813 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10814 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10815 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10816 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10817 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10818 exists.
10819
10820 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10821 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10822 unobvious parameters.
10823
10824 Example :
10825 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10826 backend public_www
10827 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10828 stats enable
10829 stats hide-version
10830 stats scope .
10831 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010832 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010833 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10834 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10835
10836 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10837 backend private_monitoring
10838 stats enable
10839 stats uri /admin?stats
10840 stats refresh 5s
10841
10842 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10843
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010844
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010845stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010846 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010848 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010849
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010850 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010851 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10852
10853 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10854 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10855
10856 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10857 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010858 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010859
10860 Example :
10861 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10862 backend private_monitoring
10863 stats enable
10864 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10865 stats uri /admin?stats
10866 stats refresh 5s
10867
10868 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10869 global section.
10870
10871
10872stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010873 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10875 yes | yes | yes | yes
10876 Arguments : none
10877
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010878 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010879 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10880 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10881 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10882 - IP (socket, server)
10883 - cookie (backend, server)
10884
10885 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10886 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010887 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010888
10889 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10890
10891
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010892stats show-modules
10893 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10895 yes | yes | yes | yes
10896 Arguments : none
10897
10898 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10899 values as a tooltip.
10900
10901 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10902 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10903 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10904
10905 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10906
10907
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010908stats show-node [ <name> ]
10909 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010911 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010912 Arguments:
10913 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10914 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10915
10916 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10917 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010918 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010919
10920 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10921 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10922 unobvious parameters.
10923
10924 Example:
10925 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10926 backend private_monitoring
10927 stats enable
10928 stats show-node Europe-1
10929 stats uri /admin?stats
10930 stats refresh 5s
10931
10932 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10933 section.
10934
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010935
10936stats uri <prefix>
10937 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010939 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010940 Arguments :
10941 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10942 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10943 query string.
10944
10945 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10946 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10947 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10948 possible to reach it in the application.
10949
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010950 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010951 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010952 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10953 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10954 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10955 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10956
10957 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10958 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10959 an address or a port to statistics only.
10960
10961 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10962 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10963 unobvious parameters.
10964
10965 Example :
10966 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10967 backend public_www
10968 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10969 stats enable
10970 stats hide-version
10971 stats scope .
10972 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010973 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010974 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10975 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10976
10977 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10978 backend private_monitoring
10979 stats enable
10980 stats uri /admin?stats
10981 stats refresh 5s
10982
10983 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10984
10985
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010986stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10987 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010989 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010990
10991 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010992 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010993 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010994 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010995 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10996
10997 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10998 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10999 the "stick-table" statement.
11000
11001 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11002 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11003 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11004 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11005 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11006
11007 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11008 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11009 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11010 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11011 transformation rules.
11012
11013 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11014 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11015 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11016 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11017 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11018 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11019 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11020
11021 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11022 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11023 ACL based conditions.
11024
11025 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11026 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11027 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11028 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11029
11030 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11031 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11032 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11033 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11034
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011035 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11036 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011037 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011038
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011039 Example :
11040 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11041 # last 30 minutes
11042 backend pop
11043 mode tcp
11044 balance roundrobin
11045 stick store-request src
11046 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11047 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11048 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11049
11050 backend smtp
11051 mode tcp
11052 balance roundrobin
11053 stick match src table pop
11054 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11055 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11056
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011057 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011058 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011059
11060
11061stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11062 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11064 no | no | yes | yes
11065
11066 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11067 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11068 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11069 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11070
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011071 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11072 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011073 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011074
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011075 Examples :
11076 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011077 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011078
11079 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11080 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11081 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11082
11083
11084 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11085 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11086 backend http
11087 mode http
11088 balance roundrobin
11089 stick on src table https
11090 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11091 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11092 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11093
11094 backend https
11095 mode tcp
11096 balance roundrobin
11097 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11098 stick on src
11099 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11100 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11101
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011102 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011103
11104
11105stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11106 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11108 no | no | yes | yes
11109
11110 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011111 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011112 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011113 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011114 server is selected.
11115
11116 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11117 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11118 the "stick-table" statement.
11119
11120 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11121 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11122 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11123 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11124 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11125 address.
11126
11127 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11128 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11129 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11130 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11131 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11132 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11133 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11134 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11135 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11136 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11137
11138 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11139 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11140 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11141 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11142 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11143 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11144 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11145
11146 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11147 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11148 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11149 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11150
11151 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11152 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11153 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11154 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11155 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11156 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011157 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11158 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11159 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11160 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11161 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11162 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011163
11164 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11165 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11166 the request.
11167
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011168 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11169 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011170 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011171
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011172 Example :
11173 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11174 # last 30 minutes
11175 backend pop
11176 mode tcp
11177 balance roundrobin
11178 stick store-request src
11179 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11180 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11181 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11182
11183 backend smtp
11184 mode tcp
11185 balance roundrobin
11186 stick match src table pop
11187 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11188 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11189
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011190 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011191 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011192
11193
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011194stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011195 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011196 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011197 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011199 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011200
11201 Arguments :
11202 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11203 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11204 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11205 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11206
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011207 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11208 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11209 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11210 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11211
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011212 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11213 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11214 instance.
11215
11216 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11217 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11218 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11219 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11220 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11221 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011222 to 32 characters.
11223
11224 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11225 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11226 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011227 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011228 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11229 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011230
11231 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011232 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11233 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011234 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11235 increase.
11236
11237 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011238 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11239 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11240 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011241
11242 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011243 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011244 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11245 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011246 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011247 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11248 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11249 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11250 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11251 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11252 parameter (see below).
11253
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011254 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11255 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11256 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11257 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11258 soft restart.
11259
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011260 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11261 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011262
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011263 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11264 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11265 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11266 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011267 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011268 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011269 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11270 if not expiration delay is specified.
11271
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011272 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11273 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11274 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11275 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11276 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11277 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11278 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11279 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11280 token.
11281
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011282 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11283 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11284 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11285 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011286 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11287 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11288 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11289 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11290 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11291 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11292 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11293 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11294 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11295 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11296 types and their arguments.
11297
11298 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11299 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11300 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11301 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11302
11303 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11304 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11305 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011306 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011307
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011308 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11309 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11310 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011311 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011312 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011313 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011314
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011315 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11316 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11317 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11318 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11319
11320 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11321 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11322 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11323 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11324 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11325 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11326
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011327 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11328 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11329 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11330 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11331
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011332 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11333 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11334 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11335 they were received.
11336
11337 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11338 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11339 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11340 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11341 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11342
11343 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11344 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11345 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11346 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11347 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11348
11349 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11350 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11351 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11352
11353 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11354 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11355 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11356 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11357 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11358
11359 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11360 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11361 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11362 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11363 the client side.
11364
11365 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11366 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11367 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11368 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11369 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11370 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11371 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11372
11373 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11374 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11375 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11376 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11377 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11378 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011379 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011380
11381 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11382 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11383 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11384 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11385 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11386 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11387
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011388 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11389 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11390 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11391 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11392 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11393
11394 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11395 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11396 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11397 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11398 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11399 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11400
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011401 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011402 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011403 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11404 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11405
11406 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11407 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11408 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11409 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11410 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11411 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11412 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11413 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11414 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11415 recommended for better fairness.
11416
11417 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011418 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011419 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11420 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11421
11422 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11423 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11424 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11425 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11426 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11427 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11428 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11429 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11430 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11431 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011432
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011433 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11434 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011435 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11436 reference it.
11437
11438 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11439 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011440 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11441 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11442 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011443
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011444 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11445 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11446 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11447 something that can be ignored.
11448
11449 Example:
11450 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11451 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11452 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11453 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11454
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011455 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011456 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011457
11458
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011459stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011460 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11462 no | no | yes | yes
11463
11464 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011465 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011466 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011467 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011468 server is selected.
11469
11470 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11471 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11472 the "stick-table" statement.
11473
11474 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11475 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11476 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11477 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11478
11479 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11480 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11481 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11482 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11483 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11484 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011485 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011486 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11487 rules.
11488
11489 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11490 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11491 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11492 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11493 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11494 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11495 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11496
11497 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11498 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11499 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11500 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11501
11502 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11503 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11504 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11505 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11506 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11507 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011508 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11509 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11510 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11511 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11512 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11513 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11514 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11515 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11516 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011517
11518 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11519
11520 Example :
11521 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11522 backend https
11523 mode tcp
11524 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011525 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011526 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011527
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011528 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11529 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11530
11531 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11532 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11533 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11534
11535 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11536 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011537
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011538 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11539 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11540 # at offset 44.
11541
11542 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11543 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11544
11545 # Learn on response if server hello.
11546 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011547
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011548 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11549 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11550
11551 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11552 extraction.
11553
11554
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011555tcp-check comment <string>
11556 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11557 it fails.
11558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11559 yes | no | yes | yes
11560
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011561 Arguments :
11562 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11563 rule fails.
11564
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011565 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11566 user-friendly error reporting.
11567
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011568 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11569 "tcp-check expect".
11570
11571
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011572tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11573 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011574 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011575 Opens a new connection
11576 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011577 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011578
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011579 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011580 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11581
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011582 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011583 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011584
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011585 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011586 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11587 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011588 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011589
11590 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011591
11592 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11593
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011594 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11595
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011596 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11597
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011598 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11599
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011600 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11601 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11602 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11603 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11604
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011605 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11606 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11607 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11608 haproxy -vv.
11609
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011610 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011611
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011612 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11613 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11614 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11615
11616 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11617 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11618 of the sequence.
11619
11620 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11621 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11622 do.
11623
11624 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11625 unset-var or comment rules.
11626
11627 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011628 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11629 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11630 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11631 option tcp-check
11632 tcp-check connect
11633 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11634 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11635 tcp-check send \r\n
11636 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11637 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11638 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11639 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11640 tcp-check send \r\n
11641 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11642 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11643
11644 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11645 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011646 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011647 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11648 tcp-check connect port 143
11649 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11650 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11651
11652 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11653
11654
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011655tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011656 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011657 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011658 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011659 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011660 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011661 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011662
11663 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011664 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11665
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011666 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11667 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11668 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11669 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11670 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11671 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11672 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11673 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11674 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11675 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11676
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011677 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011678 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11679 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011680 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11681 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11682 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11683
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011684 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11685 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11686 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011687 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11688 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011689 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11690 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011691 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11692 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011693 By default "L7OK" is used.
11694
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011695 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11696 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011697 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11698 supported :
11699 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11700 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011701 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11702 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11703 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11704 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11705 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011706
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011707 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011708 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011709 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11710 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11711 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11712 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011713 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11714
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011715 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11716 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11717 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11718 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11719
11720 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11721 informational message reported in logs if an error
11722 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11723 log-format string.
11724
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011725 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11726 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11727 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11728 followed by some converters.
11729
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011730 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11731 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11732 with the usual backslash ('\').
11733 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011734 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011735 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11736 used upper or lower case.
11737
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011738 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11739
11740 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11741 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11742 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11743 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11744 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11745 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11746 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11747 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11748
11749 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11750 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11751 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11752 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11753 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11754 expression.
11755
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011756 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11757 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11758 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11759 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11760 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11761 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11762
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011763 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11764 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11765 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11766 this exact hexadecimal string.
11767 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11768
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011769 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11770 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11771 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11772 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11773 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11774 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11775 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11776 size.
11777
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011778 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11779 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11780 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11781 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11782 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11783 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11784 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11785 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11786 in a binary string before matching the response's
11787 buffer.
11788
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011789 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011790 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011791 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11792 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11793 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11794 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11795 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11796 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11797 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11798 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11799 the null character.
11800
11801 Examples :
11802 # perform a POP check
11803 option tcp-check
11804 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11805
11806 # perform an IMAP check
11807 option tcp-check
11808 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11809
11810 # look for the redis master server
11811 option tcp-check
11812 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011813 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011814 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11815 tcp-check expect string role:master
11816 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11817 tcp-check expect string +OK
11818
11819
11820 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011821 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011822
11823
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011824tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11825tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11826 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11827 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011828 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011829 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011830
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011831 Arguments :
11832 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11833
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011834 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11835 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011836
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011837 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11838 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011839
11840 Examples :
11841 # look for the redis master server
11842 option tcp-check
11843 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11844 tcp-check expect string role:master
11845
11846 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011847 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011848
11849
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011850tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11851tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11852 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11853 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011854 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011855 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011856
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011857 Arguments :
11858 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011859
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011860 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11861 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011862
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011863 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11864 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11865 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011866
11867 Examples :
11868 # redis check in binary
11869 option tcp-check
11870 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11871 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11872
11873
11874 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011875 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011876
11877
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011878tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011879 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011880 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011881 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011882
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011883 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011884 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11885 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11886 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11887 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11888 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11889 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11890 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11891 and '-'.
11892
11893 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11894
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011895 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011896 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11897
11898
11899tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011900 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011901 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011902 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011903
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011904 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011905 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11906 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11907 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11908 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11909 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11910 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11911 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11912 and '-'.
11913
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011914 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011915 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11916
11917
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011918tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11919 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11921 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011922 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011923 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11924 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011925
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011926 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011927
11928 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11929 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011930 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11931 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11932 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11933 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11934 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11935 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011936
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011937 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11938 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11939 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11940 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011941
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011942 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011943 - accept :
11944 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11945 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11946 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011947
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011948 - reject :
11949 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11950 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11951 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11952 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11953 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11954 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11955 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11956 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11957 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11958 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11959 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011960 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011961
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011962 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11963 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11964 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11965 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11966 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11967 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11968 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11969 hosts.
11970
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011971 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11972 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11973 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11974 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11975 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11976 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11977 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11978 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11979
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011980 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11981 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11982 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11983 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11984 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11985 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11986 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11987 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11988 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011989 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11990 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011991
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011992 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011993 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011994 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11995 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11996 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011997 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011998 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011999 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12000 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12001 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12002 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12003 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12004 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12005 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012006
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012007 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012008 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012009 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012010 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012011 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12012 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12013 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012014
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012015 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12016 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12017 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12018 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012019
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012020 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12021 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12022 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12023 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12024 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012025 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12026 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12027 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12028 layer7 information is extracted.
12029
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012030 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12031 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12032 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12033 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12034 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012035
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012036 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12037 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12038 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12039 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12040
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012041 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12042 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12043 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12044 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12045
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012046 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12047 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12048 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12049 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12050 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012051
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012052 - set-src <expr> :
12053 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12054 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12055 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012056 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012057
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012058 Arguments:
12059 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12060 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012061
12062 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012063 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12064
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012065 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12066 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012067
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012068 - set-src-port <expr> :
12069 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12070 expression.
12071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012072 Arguments:
12073 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12074 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012075
12076 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012077 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12078
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012079 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12080 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12081 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012082
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012083 - set-dst <expr> :
12084 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12085 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12086 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12087 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12088 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12089
12090 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12091 followed by some converters.
12092
12093 Example:
12094
12095 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12096 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12097
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012098 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12099 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12100
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012101 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12102 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12103 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12104 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12105
12106
12107 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12108 followed by some converters.
12109
12110 Example:
12111
12112 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12113
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012114 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12115 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12116 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12117
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012118 - "silent-drop" :
12119 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012120 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012121 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12122 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12123 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12124 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12125 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012126 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12127 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012128 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12129 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012130 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012131 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12132 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12133 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12134 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12135
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012136 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12137 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12138 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012139
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012140 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12141 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12142 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012143
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012144 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012145 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012146 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012147
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012148 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12149 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12150 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012151
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012152 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012153 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12154 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012155
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012156 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12157
12158 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12159
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012160 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12161
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012162 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012163
12164
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012165tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12166 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012168 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012169 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012170 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12171 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012172
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012173 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012174
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012175 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012176 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12177 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012178 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12179 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012180
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012181 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12182 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12183 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12184 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012185 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012186 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012187 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12188 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12189 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12190 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012191 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012192 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012193
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012194 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12195 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12196 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12197 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012198
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012199 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012200 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012201 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012202 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12203 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012204 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012205 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012206 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012207 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012208 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012209 - set-dst <expr>
12210 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012211 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012212 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012213 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012214 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012215 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012216 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012217
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012218 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12219 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012220 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12221 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012222
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012223 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12224 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12225 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12226 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12227 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12228 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012230 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012231 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12232 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012233
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012234 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12235 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12236 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12237 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12238 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12239 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12240
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012241 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012242 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12243 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12244 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12245 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12246 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12247 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12248 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12249 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12250 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12251 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012252
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012253 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012254 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12255 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12256 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012257
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012258 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12259 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12260
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012261 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012262 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12263 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012264
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012265 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12266 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012267 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012268 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12269 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012270 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012271 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012272 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012273 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12274 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012275 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012276 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12277 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012278
12279 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12280 followed by some converters.
12281
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012282 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012283 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12284 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12285 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12286 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12287 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12288 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012289 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012290 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12291 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12292
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012293 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12294
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012295 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12296 <var-name>.
12297
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012298 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12299 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12300 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12301 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12302 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12303
12304 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12305 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12306 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12307 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12308 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12309 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12310 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12311 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12312 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12313 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12314 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12315
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012316 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12317 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12318 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12319 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12320 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12321
12322 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12323
12324 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12325
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012326 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12327 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12328 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12329 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12330 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12331 evaluated.
12332
12333 Example:
12334 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12335
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012336 Example:
12337
12338 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012339 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012340
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012341 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012342 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012343 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012344 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12345 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012346 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012347 tcp-request content reject
12348
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012349 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12350 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12351 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12352 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12353 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12354 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12355 ...
12356 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12357
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012358 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012359 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12360 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12361 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012362 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012363
12364 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12365 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12366 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012367 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012368 tcp-request content reject
12369
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012370 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012371 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012372 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012373 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012374 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12375 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012376
12377 Example:
12378 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12379 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012380 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012381
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012382 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012383 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012384
12385 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012386 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012387 # protecting all our sites
12388 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012389 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12390 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012391 ...
12392 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12393
12394 backend http_dynamic
12395 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012396 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012397 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012398 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012399 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012400 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012401 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012403 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012404
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012405 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12406 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012407
12408
12409tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12410 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012412 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012413 Arguments :
12414 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12415 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12416 as explained at the top of this document.
12417
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012418 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012419 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12420 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12421 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12422 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12423
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012424 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12425 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12426 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12427 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12428
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012429 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012430 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012431 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012432 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012433 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012434 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12435 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12436 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012437
12438 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12439 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12440 it pass through unaffected.
12441
12442 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12443 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12444 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012445 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012446 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12447 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012448 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12449 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12450 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012451
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012452 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012453 "timeout client".
12454
12455
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012456tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12457 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12459 no | no | yes | yes
12460 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012461 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12462 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012463
12464 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12465
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012466 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012467 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12468 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012469 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12470 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012471
12472 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12473
12474 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12475 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12476 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12477 inserted.
12478
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012479 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012480 - accept :
12481 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12482 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12483 the rules evaluation.
12484
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012485 - close :
12486 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12487 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12488 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12489 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12490 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12491 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012492 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012493 protocols.
12494
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012495 - reject :
12496 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12497 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012498 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012499
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012500 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012501 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012502
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012503 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12504 Unsets a variable.
12505
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012506 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12507 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12508 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12509 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12510
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012511 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12512 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12513 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12514 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12515
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012516 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12517 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12518 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12519 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12520 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012521
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012522 - "silent-drop" :
12523 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012524 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012525 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12526 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12527 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12528 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12529 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012530 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12531 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012532 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12533 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012534 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012535 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12536 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12537 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12538 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12539
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012540 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12541 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12542
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012543 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12544 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12545 for changing the default action to a reject.
12546
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012547 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12548 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12549 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12550 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012551 period.
12552
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012553 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12554 declared inline.
12555
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012556 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12557 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012558 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012559 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12560 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012561 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012562 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012563 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012564 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12565 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012566 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012567 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12568 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012569
12570 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12571 followed by some converters.
12572
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012573 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12574 <var-name>.
12575
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012576 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12577 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12578 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12579 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12580 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12581
12582 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12583
12584 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12585
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012586 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12587
12588 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12589
12590
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012591tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12592 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12594 no | yes | yes | no
12595 Arguments :
12596 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12597 below.
12598
12599 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12600
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012601 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012602 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12603 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12604 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12605 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12606 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12607 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12608 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012609 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012610 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12611 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12612 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12613 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12614 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12615 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12616 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12617 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12618 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12619 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12620 instead.
12621
12622 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12623 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12624 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12625 rules which may be inserted.
12626
12627 Several types of actions are supported :
12628 - accept : the request is accepted
12629 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12630 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12631 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012632 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012633 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012634 - set-dst <expr>
12635 - set-dst-port <expr>
12636 - set-src <expr>
12637 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012638 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012639 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012640 - silent-drop
12641
12642 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12643 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12644 sections for a complete description.
12645
12646 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12647 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12648 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12649
12650 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12651 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12652 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12653 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12654 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12655
12656 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12657 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12658
12659 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12660 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12661 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12662
12663 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12664 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12665 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12666
12667 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12668 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12669 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12670
12671 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12672 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12673 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12674
12675 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12676
12677 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12678
12679
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012680tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12681 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12683 no | no | yes | yes
12684 Arguments :
12685 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12686 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12687 as explained at the top of this document.
12688
12689 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12690
12691
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012692timeout check <timeout>
12693 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12694 established.
12695
12696 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12697 yes | no | yes | yes
12698 Arguments:
12699 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12700 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12701 as explained at the top of this document.
12702
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012703 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012704 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012705 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012706 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012707 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12708 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12709 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012710
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012711 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012712 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12713
12714 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12715 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012716 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012717
12718 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12719 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12720 forget about it.
12721
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012722 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12723 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012724
12725
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012726timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012727 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12729 yes | yes | yes | no
12730 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012731 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012732 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12733 as explained at the top of this document.
12734
12735 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12736 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12737 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012738 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12739 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12740 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12741 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012742 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12743 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12744 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012745 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012746 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012747 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12748 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012749 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12750 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012751
12752 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12753 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12754 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12755 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012756 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012757 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12758
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012759 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012760
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012761 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012762
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012763
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012764timeout client-fin <timeout>
12765 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12767 yes | yes | yes | no
12768 Arguments :
12769 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12770 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12771 as explained at the top of this document.
12772
12773 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12774 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12775 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12776 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12777 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12778 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12779 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012780 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12781 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12782 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012783
12784 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12785 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12786 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12787
12788 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12789
12790
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012791timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012792 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12794 yes | no | yes | yes
12795 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012796 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012797 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12798 as explained at the top of this document.
12799
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012800 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012801 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012802 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012803 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012804 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12805 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012806
12807 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12808 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12809 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12810 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012811 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012812 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12813
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012814 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012816
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012817timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12818 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12820 yes | yes | yes | yes
12821 Arguments :
12822 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12823 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12824 as explained at the top of this document.
12825
12826 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12827 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12828 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12829 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12830 once the request has started to present itself.
12831
12832 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12833 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12834 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12835 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12836 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12837
12838 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12839 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12840 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12841 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12842
12843 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12844 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012845 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012846 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12847 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012848 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012849
12850 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12851 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12852 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12853 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12854
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012855 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12856 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012857 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12858
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012859 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12860
12861
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012862timeout http-request <timeout>
12863 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012865 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012866 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012867 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012868 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12869 as explained at the top of this document.
12870
12871 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12872 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12873 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12874 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12875 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12876 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12877 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012878 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12879 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12880 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12881 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012882 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012883 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12884 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012885
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012886 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12887 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12888 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12889 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12890 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012891 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012892
12893 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12894 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012895 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012896 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12897 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12898
12899 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012900 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12901 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12902 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012903
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012904 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012905 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012906
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012907
12908timeout queue <timeout>
12909 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12911 yes | no | yes | yes
12912 Arguments :
12913 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12914 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12915 as explained at the top of this document.
12916
12917 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12918 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12919 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12920 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12921 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12922
12923 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12924 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12925 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12926 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12927
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012928 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012929
12930
12931timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012932 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12934 yes | no | yes | yes
12935 Arguments :
12936 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12937 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12938 as explained at the top of this document.
12939
12940 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12941 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12942 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12943 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12944 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12945 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12946 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12947
12948 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12949 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12950 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12951 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12952 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012953 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012954 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012955 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12956 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012957 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12958 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012959
12960 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12961 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12962 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12963 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012964 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012965 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12966
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012967 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012968
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012969
12970timeout server-fin <timeout>
12971 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12973 yes | no | yes | yes
12974 Arguments :
12975 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12976 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12977 as explained at the top of this document.
12978
12979 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12980 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12981 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12982 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12983 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12984 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12985 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12986 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12987 situations, it should not be needed.
12988
12989 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12990 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12991 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12992
12993 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12994
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012995
12996timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012997 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12999 yes | yes | yes | yes
13000 Arguments :
13001 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13002 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13003 as explained at the top of this document.
13004
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013005 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13006 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13007 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013008
13009 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13010 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13011 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13012 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013013 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013014
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013015 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013016
13017
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013018timeout tunnel <timeout>
13019 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13021 yes | no | yes | yes
13022 Arguments :
13023 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13024 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13025 as explained at the top of this document.
13026
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013027 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013028 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13029 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13030 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013031 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13032 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013033 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13034 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13035 specified.
13036
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013037 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13038 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13039 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13040 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13041 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13042 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13043 state.
13044
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013045 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13046 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13047 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13048 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013049 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013050
13051 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13052 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13053 forget about it.
13054
13055 Example :
13056 defaults http
13057 option http-server-close
13058 timeout connect 5s
13059 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013060 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013061 timeout server 30s
13062 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13063
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013064 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013065
13066
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013067transparent (deprecated)
13068 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013070 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013071 Arguments : none
13072
13073 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13074 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13075 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13076 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13077 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13078 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13079 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13080 appropriate server.
13081
13082 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13083
13084 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13085 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13086
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013087 See also: "option transparent"
13088
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013089unique-id-format <string>
13090 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13092 yes | yes | yes | no
13093 Arguments :
13094 <string> is a log-format string.
13095
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013096 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13097 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13098 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13099 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013100
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013101 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013102 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013103 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13104 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13105 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13106 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13107 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13108 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013109
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013110 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13111 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013112
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013113 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013114
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013115 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013116
13117 will generate:
13118
13119 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13120
13121 See also: "unique-id-header"
13122
13123unique-id-header <name>
13124 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13126 yes | yes | yes | no
13127 Arguments :
13128 <name> is the name of the header.
13129
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013130 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13131 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013132
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013133 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013134
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013135 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013136 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13137
13138 will generate:
13139
13140 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13141
13142 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013143
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013144use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013145 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13147 no | yes | yes | no
13148 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013149 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13150 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013151
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013152 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13153 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013154
13155 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13156 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13157 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013158 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013159 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013160 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13161 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013162
13163 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13164 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13165 assign the backend.
13166
13167 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13168 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13169 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13170 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13171 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13172 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13173
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013174 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013175 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013176 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13177 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13178 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13179
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013180 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13181 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13182 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13183 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13184 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13185 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13186 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13187 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13188 cannot be forced from the request.
13189
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013190 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013191 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13192 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13193
13194 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13195 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013196
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013197use-fcgi-app <name>
13198 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13200 no | no | yes | yes
13201 Arguments :
13202 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13203
13204 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013205
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013206use-server <server> if <condition>
13207use-server <server> unless <condition>
13208 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13210 no | no | yes | yes
13211 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013212 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13213 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013214
13215 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13216
13217 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13218 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13219 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13220
13221 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13222 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13223 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13224 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13225 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13226 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13227 matches will assign the server.
13228
13229 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13230 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13231 with the next rules until one matches.
13232
13233 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13234 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13235 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13236 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13237
13238 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13239 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13240 stripped.
13241
13242 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13243 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013244 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013245 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013246 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013247
13248 Example :
13249 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013250 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013251 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013252 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013253 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013254 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013255 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013256 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13257 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13258
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013259 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13260 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13261 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13262 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013263 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013264 and we fall back to load balancing.
13265
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013266 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013267
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013268
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132695. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013270--------------------------
13271
13272The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13273depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13274settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13275written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13276described in this section.
13277
13278
132795.1. Bind options
13280-----------------
13281
13282The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13283as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13284no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13285parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13286while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13287provided immediately after the setting name.
13288
13289The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13290
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013291accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13292 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13293 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13294 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13295 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13296 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13297 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13298 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13299 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13300 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013301 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13302 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13303 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013304
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013305accept-proxy
13306 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013307 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13308 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013309 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13310 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13311 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13312 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013313 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013314 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13315 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013316 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13317 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013318
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013319allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013320 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013321 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013322 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013323 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13324 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013325
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013326alpn <protocols>
13327 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13328 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13329 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013330 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013331 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013332 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13333 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13334 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13335 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13336 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13337 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13338 preference, like below :
13339
13340 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013341
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013342backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013343 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013344 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13345
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013346curves <curves>
13347 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13348 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13349 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13350 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13351 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13352 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13353
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013354ecdhe <named curve>
13355 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013356 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13357 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013358
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013359ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013360 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13361 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13362 client's certificate.
13363
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013364ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13365 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13366 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13367 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13368 error is ignored.
13369
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013370ca-sign-file <cafile>
13371 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13372 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13373 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13374 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13375 'generate-certificates' for details.
13376
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013377ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013378 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13379 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13380 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13381 'generate-certificates' for details.
13382
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013383ca-verify-file <cafile>
13384 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13385 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13386 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13387 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13388 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13389
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013390ciphers <ciphers>
13391 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13392 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013393 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013394 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013395 information and recommendations see e.g.
13396 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13397 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13398 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13399
13400ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13401 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13402 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13403 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13404 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013405 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13406 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013407
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013408crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013409 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13410 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013411 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13412 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013413
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013414crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013415 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13416 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13417 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13418 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13419 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013420 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13421 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013422
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013423 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13424 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13425
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013426 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13427 are loaded.
13428
13429 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013430 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13431 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13432 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13433 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13434 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13435 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13436 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013437 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013438
13439 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13440 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13441 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13442 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013443 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13444 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013445
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013446 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013447
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013448 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013449 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013450 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13451 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013452 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13453 clients).
13454
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013455 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013456 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13457 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13458 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13459 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13460 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13461 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13462 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13463 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13464 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13465 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13466 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13467 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13468
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013469 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013470 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13471 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13472 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13473 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13474
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013475 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13476 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13477 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13478 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013479
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013480 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13481 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13482 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013483
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013484crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013486 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013487 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013488 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013489
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013490crt-list <file>
13491 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013492 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13493 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013494
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013495 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13496
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013497 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13498 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13499 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13500 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13501 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013502
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013503 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013504 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13505 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13506 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13507 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13508 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013509 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13510 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13511 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013512
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013513 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13514 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13515 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013516
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013517 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13518
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013519 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013520 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013521 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13522 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13523 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13524 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13525 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13526 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013527
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013528 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013529 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013530 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013531 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013532 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013533 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013534
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013535defer-accept
13536 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13537 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13538 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013539 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013540 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13541 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13542 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13543 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13544 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13545 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13546 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13547
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013548expose-fd listeners
13549 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13550 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013551 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13552 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013553 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013554
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013555force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013556 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013557 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013558 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013559 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013560
13561force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013562 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013563 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013564 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013565
13566force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013567 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013568 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013569 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013570
13571force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013572 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013573 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013574 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013575
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013576force-tlsv13
13577 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13578 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013579 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013580
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013581generate-certificates
13582 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13583 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13584 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13585 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13586 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13587 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13588 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13589 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13590 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13591 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13592 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13593
13594 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13595 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013596 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013597 certificate is used many times.
13598
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013599gid <gid>
13600 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13601 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13602 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13603 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13604 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13605
13606group <group>
13607 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13608 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13609 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13610 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13611 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13612
13613id <id>
13614 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13615 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13616 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13617 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13618
13619interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013620 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13621 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13622 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13623 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13624 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13625 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013626 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13627 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13628 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13629 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13630 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13631 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013632
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013633level <level>
13634 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13635 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13636 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013637 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013638 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13639 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13640 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013641 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013642 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013643 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013644 all counters).
13645
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013646severity-output <format>
13647 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13648 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13649 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13650 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13651 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13652 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13653 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13654 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13655 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13656 rfc5424 convention.
13657
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013658maxconn <maxconn>
13659 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13660 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13661 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13662 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13663 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13664 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13665 eat all memory.
13666
13667mode <mode>
13668 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13669 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13670 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13671 UNIX sockets.
13672
13673mss <maxseg>
13674 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13675 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13676 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13677 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13678 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13679 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13680 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13681 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13682 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13683 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13684 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13685
13686name <name>
13687 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13688 page.
13689
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013690namespace <name>
13691 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13692 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13693 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13694 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13695
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013696nice <nice>
13697 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13698 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13699 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13700 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13701 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13702 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13703 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13704 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13705 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13706 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13707 one for an RDP socket.
13708
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013709no-ca-names
13710 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13711 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013712 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013713
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013714no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013715 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013716 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013717 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013718 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013719 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13720 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013721
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013722no-tls-tickets
13723 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13724 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13725 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013726 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13727 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013728 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13729 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13730 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013731
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013732no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013733 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013734 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013735 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013736 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013737 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13738 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013739
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013740no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013741 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013742 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013743 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013744 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013745 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13746 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013747
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013748no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013749 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013750 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013751 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013752 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013753 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13754 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013755
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013756no-tlsv13
13757 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13758 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13759 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13760 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013761 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13762 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013763
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013764npn <protocols>
13765 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13766 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13767 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013768 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013769 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013770 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13771 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13772 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13773 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13774 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013775
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013776prefer-client-ciphers
13777 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13778 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13779 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013780 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13781 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13782 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013783
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013784process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013785 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013786 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013787 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013788 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13789 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13790 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13791 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013792 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013793 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13794 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13795 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13796 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13797 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013798
13799 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13800
13801 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13802 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13803 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13804 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13805 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13806 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13807 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13808 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013809
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013810proto <name>
13811 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13812 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13813 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013814 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13815 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13816
13817 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13818 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13819 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13820 also reported (flag=HTX).
13821
13822 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13823 a bind line :
13824
13825 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13826 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13827 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13828
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013829 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013830 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013831 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013832 h2" on the bind line.
13833
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013834ssl
13835 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013836 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013837 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13838 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013839 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13840 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013841
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013842ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13843 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013844 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13845 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13846 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013847 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13848
13849ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013850 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13851 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13852 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13853 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013854
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013855strict-sni
13856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13857 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13858 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13859 See the "crt" option for more information.
13860
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013861tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013862 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013863 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013864 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013865 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013866 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13867 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13868 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13869 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13870 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13871 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13872 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13873
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013874tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013875 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013876 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13877 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13878 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13879 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13880 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13881 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13882 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013883 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13884 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13885 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013886
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013887tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13888 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013889 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13890 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13891 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13892 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13893 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13894 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13895 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13896 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13897 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13898 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013899 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13900 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13901
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013902transparent
13903 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13904 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13905 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13906 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13907 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13908 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13909 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13910 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13911 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13912 so check for support with your vendor.
13913
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013914v4v6
13915 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13916 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13917 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13918 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013919 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013920
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013921v6only
13922 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13923 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13924 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013925 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13926 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013927
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013928uid <uid>
13929 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13930 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13931 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13932 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13933 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13934
13935user <user>
13936 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13937 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13938 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13939 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13940 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13941
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013942verify [none|optional|required]
13943 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13944 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13945 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13946 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13947 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013948 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13949 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13950 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13951 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013952
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200139535.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013954------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013956The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13957which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13958arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13959settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13960after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13961Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13962address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013964 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013965 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013966
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013967Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13968keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013970The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013971
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013972addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013973 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013974 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13975 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13976 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13977 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13978 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013979
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013980agent-check
13981 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013982 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013983 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13984 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13985 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013986
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013987 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013988 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013989 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013990 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13991 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013992
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013993 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13994 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13995 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13996 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13997 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013998
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013999 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014000 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014001
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014002 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14003 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14004 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014005
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014006 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14007 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14008 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014009
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014010 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014011 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14012 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14013 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14014 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014015 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014016 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014017
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014018 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14019 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014020
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014021 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14022 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14023 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14024 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14025 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14026 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14027 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14028 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14029 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014030
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014031 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14032 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014033 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14034 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14035 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014036 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014037
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014038 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014039 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014040
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014041agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014042 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014043 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14044 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14045 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14046 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14047
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014048agent-inter <delay>
14049 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14050 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14051
14052 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14053 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14054 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14055 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14056 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14057 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14058 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14059 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14060 of backends use the same servers.
14061
14062 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14063
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014064agent-addr <addr>
14065 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14066
14067 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014068 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014069 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14070 hostname, it will be resolved.
14071
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014072agent-port <port>
14073 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14074
14075 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14076
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014077allow-0rtt
14078 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014079 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14080 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014081
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014082alpn <protocols>
14083 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14084 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14085 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014086 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014087 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14088 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14089 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14090 now obsolete NPN extension.
14091 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14092 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14093
14094 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014096backup
14097 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14098 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14099 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14100 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014101 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14102 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014103
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014104ca-file <cafile>
14105 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14106 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14107 server's certificate.
14108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014109check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014110 This option enables health checks on a server:
14111 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14112 considered available.
14113 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14114 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14115 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14116 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14117 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14118 set.
14119 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14120 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14121 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14122 exchanges succeed.
14123
14124 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14125 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14126 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14127 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14128 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014129 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014130 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14131
14132 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14133 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14134
14135 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14136 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14137
14138 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14139 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14140 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14141 available.
14142
14143 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14144 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14145 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14146
14147 Example:
14148 # simple tcp check
14149 backend foo
14150 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14151 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14152 backend foo
14153 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14154 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14155 backend foo
14156 option tcp-check
14157 tcp-check connect
14158 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014159
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014160check-send-proxy
14161 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14162 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14163 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14164 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14165 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14166 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14167 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14168
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014169check-alpn <protocols>
14170 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14171 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14172 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14173
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014174check-proto <name>
14175 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14176 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14177 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014178 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14179 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14180
14181 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14182 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14183 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14184 also reported (flag=HTX).
14185
14186 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14187 directive on a server line:
14188
14189 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14190 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14191 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14192 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14193
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014194 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014195 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14196 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14197
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014198check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014199 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014200 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14201 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014202
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014203check-ssl
14204 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14205 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14206 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14207 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014208 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014209 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14210 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014211 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014212 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14213 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014214
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014215check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014216 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014217 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14218 for normal traffic.
14219
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014220ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14222 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14223 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014224 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14225 information and recommendations see e.g.
14226 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14227 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14228 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014229
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014230ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14231 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14232 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14233 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14234 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014235 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14236 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14237 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014239cookie <value>
14240 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14241 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14242 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14243 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14244 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14245 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14246 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14247
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014248crl-file <crlfile>
14249 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14250 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14251 to verify server's certificate.
14252
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014253crt <cert>
14254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14255 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14256 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14257 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14258 certificate request.
14259
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014260 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14261 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14262 option is set accordingly).
14263
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014264disabled
14265 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14266 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14267 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14268 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14269 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014270 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014271
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014272enabled
14273 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14274 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14275 default value.
14276 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14277 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014278
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014279error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014280 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14281 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14282 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014284 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014286fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014287 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14288 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14289 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14290
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014291force-sslv3
14292 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14293 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014294 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014295 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014296
14297force-tlsv10
14298 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014299 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014300 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014301
14302force-tlsv11
14303 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014304 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014305 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014306
14307force-tlsv12
14308 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014309 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014310 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014311
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014312force-tlsv13
14313 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14314 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014315 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014317id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014318 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14319 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14320 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014321
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014322init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14323 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14324 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014325 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014326 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14327 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14328 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14329 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14330 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14331 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14332 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14333 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14334 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014335 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014336 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14337 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14338 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14339 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14340 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14341 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014342 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014343
14344 Example:
14345 defaults
14346 # never fail on address resolution
14347 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14348
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014349inter <delay>
14350fastinter <delay>
14351downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014352 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14353 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14354 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14355 between checks depending on the server state :
14356
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014357 Server state | Interval used
14358 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14359 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14360 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14361 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14362 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14363 or yet unchecked. |
14364 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14365 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14366 | "inter" otherwise.
14367 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014369 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14370 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14371 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14372 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014373 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14374 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14375 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14376 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14377 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014378
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014379log-proto <logproto>
14380 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14381 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14382 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14383 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14384
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014385maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014386 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14387 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014388 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14389 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014390 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14391 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14392 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14393 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14394
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014395 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14396 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14397 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14398 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14399 than 50 concurrent requests.
14400
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014401maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014402 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14403 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14404 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14405 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014406 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14407 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14408 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14409 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14410 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14411 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14412 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014413
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014414max-reuse <count>
14415 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14416 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14417 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14418 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14419 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14420 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14421 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14422 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014424minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014425 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14426 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14427 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14428 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14429 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14430 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014431 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014432 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014433
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014434namespace <name>
14435 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14436 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14437 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14438 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14439
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014440no-agent-check
14441 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14442 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14443 default value.
14444 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14445 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14446
14447no-backup
14448 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14449 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14450 default value.
14451 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14452 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14453
14454no-check
14455 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14456 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14457 default value.
14458 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14459 "default-server" "check" setting.
14460
14461no-check-ssl
14462 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14463 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14464 default value.
14465 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14466 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14467
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014468no-send-proxy
14469 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14470 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14471 default value.
14472 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14473 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14474
14475no-send-proxy-v2
14476 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14477 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14478 default value.
14479 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14480 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14481
14482no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14483 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14484 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14485 default value.
14486 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14487 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14488
14489no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14490 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14491 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14492 default value.
14493 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14494 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14495
14496no-ssl
14497 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14498 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14499 default value.
14500 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14501 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14502
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014503 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14504 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14505 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14506
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014507no-ssl-reuse
14508 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14509 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14510 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14511 and for paranoid users.
14512
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014513no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014514 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14515 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014516 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014517
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014518 Supported in default-server: No
14519
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014520no-tls-tickets
14521 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14522 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14523 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014524 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14525 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014526 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14527 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14528 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014529 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014530
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014531no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014532 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014533 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14534 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014535 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14536 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014537 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014538
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014539 Supported in default-server: No
14540
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014541no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014542 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014543 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14544 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014545 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14546 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014547 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014548
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014549 Supported in default-server: No
14550
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014551no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014552 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014553 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14554 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014555 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14556 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014557 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014558
14559 Supported in default-server: No
14560
14561no-tlsv13
14562 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14563 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14564 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14565 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14566 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014567 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014568
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014569 Supported in default-server: No
14570
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014571no-verifyhost
14572 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14573 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14574 default value.
14575 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14576 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014577
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014578no-tfo
14579 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14580 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14581 default value.
14582 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14583 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14584
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014585non-stick
14586 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14587 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14588 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14589
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014590npn <protocols>
14591 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14592 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14593 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014594 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014595 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14596 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14597 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14598
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014599observe <mode>
14600 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14601 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14602 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14603 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14604 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14605 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014606 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014607
14608 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014610on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014611 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14612 Currently, four modes are available:
14613 - fastinter: force fastinter
14614 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14615 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14616 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14617 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14618
14619 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14620
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014621on-marked-down <action>
14622 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14623 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014624 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14625 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14626 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14627 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14628 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14629 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14630 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14631 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014632
14633 Actions are disabled by default
14634
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014635on-marked-up <action>
14636 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14637 Currently one action is available:
14638 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14639 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14640 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14641 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014642 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14643 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014644 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14645 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14646
14647 Actions are disabled by default
14648
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014649pool-low-conn <max>
14650 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14651 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14652 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14653 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14654 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14655 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14656 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14657 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14658 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14659 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014660 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14661 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14662 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14663 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014664
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014665pool-max-conn <max>
14666 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14667 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14668 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14669 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14670 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14671 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14672
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014673pool-purge-delay <delay>
14674 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014675 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014676 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014678port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014679 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014680 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14681 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14682 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14683 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14684 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014685
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014686proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014687 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14688 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14689 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014690 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14691 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14692
14693 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14694 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14695 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14696 also reported (flag=HTX).
14697
14698 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14699 a server line :
14700
14701 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14702 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14703 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14704 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14705
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014706 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014707 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014709redir <prefix>
14710 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14711 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14712 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14713 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14714 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14715 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14716 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14717 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014718 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014719 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014720 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14721 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14722 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14723 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14724
14725 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014727rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014728 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14729 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14730 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14731
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014732resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14733 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14734 server.
14735
14736 Available options:
14737
14738 * allow-dup-ip
14739 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14740 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14741 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14742 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14743 For such case, simply enable this option.
14744 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14745
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014746 * ignore-weight
14747 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14748 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14749 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14750
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014751 * prevent-dup-ip
14752 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14753 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14754 same fqdn.
14755 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14756
14757 Example:
14758 backend b_myapp
14759 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14760 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14761 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14762
14763 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14764 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14765 it
14766 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14767 different address
14768
14769 Default value: not set
14770
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014771resolve-prefer <family>
14772 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14773 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14774 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14775 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14776
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014777 Default value: ipv6
14778
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014779 Example:
14780
14781 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014782
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014783resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014784 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014785 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014786 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014787 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14788 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014789 configured network, another address is selected.
14790
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014791 Example:
14792
14793 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014794
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014795resolvers <id>
14796 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14797 hostname.
14798
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014799 Example:
14800
14801 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014802
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014803 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014804
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014805send-proxy
14806 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14807 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14808 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14809 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014810 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14811 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14812 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14813 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014814 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014815 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14816 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14817 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14818 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14819 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014820 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14821 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014822
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014823send-proxy-v2
14824 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14825 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14826 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14827 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014828 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14829 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14830 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14831 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014832
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014833proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014834 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14835 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14836
14837 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14838 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14839 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14840 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14841 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14842 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14843 connection is supported).
14844 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14845 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14846 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14847 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14848 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14849 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14850 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014851
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014852send-proxy-v2-ssl
14853 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14854 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14855 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14856 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14857 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14858 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14859 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014860 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14861 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014862
14863send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14864 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14865 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14866 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14867 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14868 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14869 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14870 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14871 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014872 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14873 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014874
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014875slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014876 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14877 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14878 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14879 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14880 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14881 parameters :
14882
14883 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14884 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14885
14886 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14887 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14888 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14889 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14890
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014891 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014892 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14893 seen as failed.
14894
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014895sni <expression>
14896 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14897 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14898 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14899 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014900 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14901 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014902 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014903 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14904 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014905
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014906source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014907source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014908source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014909 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14910 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14911 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14912 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14913
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014914 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14915 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14916 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14917 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14918 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14919 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14920 server.
14921
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014922 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14923 specifying the source address without port(s).
14924
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014925ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014926 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14927 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14928 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14929 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14930 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14931 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014932 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14933 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014934
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014935ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14936 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14937 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14938 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14939
14940ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14941 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14942 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14943 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14944
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014945ssl-reuse
14946 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14947 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14948 default value.
14949 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14950 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14951
14952stick
14953 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14954 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14955 default value.
14956 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14957 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014958
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014959socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014960 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014961 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14962 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14963
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014964tcp-ut <delay>
14965 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014966 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014967 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014968 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014969 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14970 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14971 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14972 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14973 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14974 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14975 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14976 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14977 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14978
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014979tfo
14980 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14981 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14982 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14983 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014984 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014985 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014987track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014988 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14989 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14990 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14991 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014992 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14993
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014994tls-tickets
14995 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14996 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14997 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014998 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14999 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15000 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015001 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015002 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015003
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015004verify [none|required]
15005 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015006 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015007 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15008 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015009 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015010 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15011 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15012 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15013 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15014 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15015 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15016 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15017 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015018
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015019verifyhost <hostname>
15020 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015021 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15022 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15023 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15024 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15025 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15026 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15027 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15028 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015030weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015031 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15032 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15033 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015034 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15035 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15036 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15037 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15038 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15039 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015040
15041
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150425.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15043-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015044
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015045HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15046using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015047configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015048This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15049can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15050workload.
15051This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15052resolution at run time.
15053Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15054carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15055
15056
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150575.3.1. Global overview
15058----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015059
15060As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15061different steps of the process life:
15062
15063 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15064 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15065 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15066
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015067 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15068 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015069
15070A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15071 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15072 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15073 resolution to know this new IP.
15074
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015075When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015076HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015077SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15078from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015079will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015080will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015081
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015082A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015083 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015084 first valid response.
15085
15086 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15087 servers return an error.
15088
15089
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150905.3.2. The resolvers section
15091----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015092
15093This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015094HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15095contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015096
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015097When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15098uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15099is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15100answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15101
15102When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015103used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015104
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015105 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15106 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15107 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015108
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015109 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15110 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015111
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015112 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15113 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15114 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015115
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015116For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15117following scenarios are possible:
15118
15119 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15120 ignored
15121
15122 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15123 applied
15124
15125 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15126 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15127
15128 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15129 retries the query with a new type
15130
15131 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15132 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015133
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015134As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015135a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015136<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015137
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015138
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015139resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015140 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015141
15142A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15143
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015144accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015145 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015146 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015147 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15148 by RFC 6891)
15149
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015150 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15151 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15152 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15153 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15154 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15155 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015156
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015157nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15158 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15159 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15160 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15161 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15162 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15163 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15164 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15165 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15166 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015167 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15168
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015169parse-resolv-conf
15170 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15171 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15172 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15173
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015174hold <status> <period>
15175 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15176 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015177 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015178 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015179 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15180 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15181 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15182
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015183 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015184
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015185resolve_retries <nb>
15186 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15187 giving up.
15188 Default value: 3
15189
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015190 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15191 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15192 type.
15193
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015194timeout <event> <time>
15195 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15196 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15197 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015198 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15199 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015200 Default value: 1s
15201 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015202 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015203 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015204 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15205 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15206
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015207 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015208
15209 resolvers mydns
15210 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15211 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015212 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015213 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015214 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015215 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015216 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015217 hold other 30s
15218 hold refused 30s
15219 hold nx 30s
15220 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015221 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015222 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015223
15224
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200152256. Cache
15226---------
15227
15228HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15229(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15230RAM.
15231
15232The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15233this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15234
15235If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15236independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15237when we try to allocate a new one.
15238
15239The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15240
15241It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15242"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15243for more details.
15244
15245When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15246replaced by "<CACHE>".
15247
15248
152496.1. Limitation
15250----------------
15251
15252The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15253
15254- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015255- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15256 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15257 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015258- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15259- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015260- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15261 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15262 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015263- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15264 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015265- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15266 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15267 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015268
15269- If the request is not a GET
15270- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15271- If the request contains an Authorization header
15272
15273
152746.2. Setup
15275-----------
15276
15277To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15278the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15279
15280
152816.2.1. Cache section
15282---------------------
15283
15284cache <name>
15285 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15286 size of cache is mandatory.
15287
15288total-max-size <megabytes>
15289 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15290 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15291
15292max-object-size <bytes>
15293 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15294 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15295 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15296
15297max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015298 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015299 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15300 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15301 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15302 default.
15303
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015304process-vary <on/off>
15305 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015306 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15307 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15308 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015309 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015310
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015311max-secondary-entries <number>
15312 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15313 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15314 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15315
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015316
153176.2.2. Proxy section
15318---------------------
15319
15320http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15321 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15322 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15323 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15324 after this one.
15325
15326http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15327 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15328 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15329 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15330 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15331
15332
15333Example:
15334
15335 backend bck1
15336 mode http
15337
15338 http-request cache-use foobar
15339 http-response cache-store foobar
15340 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15341
15342 cache foobar
15343 total-max-size 4
15344 max-age 240
15345
15346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153477. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15348----------------------------------
15349
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015350HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015351client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15352The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15353these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15354but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15355data called patterns.
15356
15357
153587.1. ACL basics
15359---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015360
15361The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15362content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15363from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15364simple :
15365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015366 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015367 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015368 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15369 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015371The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15372adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015373
15374In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015376 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015377
15378This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15379Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15380and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015381an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15382conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15383as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15384are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015385
15386ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15387'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15388which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15389
15390There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15391performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015393The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15394specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15395this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015396methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15397ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015398
15399Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15400 - boolean
15401 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15402 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15403 - string
15404 - data block
15405
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015406Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15407converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15408would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15409The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15410which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15411
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015412Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15413keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15414fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15415which are summarized in the table below :
15416
15417 +---------------------+-----------------+
15418 | Sample or converter | Default |
15419 | output type | matching method |
15420 +---------------------+-----------------+
15421 | boolean | bool |
15422 +---------------------+-----------------+
15423 | integer | int |
15424 +---------------------+-----------------+
15425 | ip | ip |
15426 +---------------------+-----------------+
15427 | string | str |
15428 +---------------------+-----------------+
15429 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15430 +---------------------+-----------------+
15431
15432Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15433matching method, see below.
15434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015435The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15436 - boolean
15437 - integer or integer range
15438 - IP address / network
15439 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15440 - regular expression
15441 - hex block
15442
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015443The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15444
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015445 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15446 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015447 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015448 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015449 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015450 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015451 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015453The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15454read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15455if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15456lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15457will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15458beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015459a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015460lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15461exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15462
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015463The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15464parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15465ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15466a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15467check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15468
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015469The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15470socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15471file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015473Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15474loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15475
15476 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15477
15478In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15479the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15480case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15481as well.
15482
15483The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15484sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15485do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15486methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15487is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015488obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15490default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15491that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15492string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15493
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015494The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15495By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15496string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15497resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015498server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015499waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015500flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15501function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015503There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15504sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15505be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015506
15507 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15508 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015509 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15510 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15511 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15512 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015513
15514 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15515 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015516 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015517
15518 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015519 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015520
15521 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015522 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015523
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015524 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015525 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15526
15527 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15528 binary or string samples.
15529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015530 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15531 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015533 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15534 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15535 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015537 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15538 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015540 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15541 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15544 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15547 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015548 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015550 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15551 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15552 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015553
15554For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15555request, it is possible to do :
15556
15557 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15558
15559In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15560buffer, one would use the following acl :
15561
15562 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15563
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015564On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15565possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15566
15567 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15570criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15571method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15572to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15573criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15574the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015576If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015577the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15578For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015580 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15581 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15582 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15583 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015584
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015585
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015586The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15587types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15588combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15589brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15590default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015592 +-------------------------------------------------+
15593 | Input sample type |
15594 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015595 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015596 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15597 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15598 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015599 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015601 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015602 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015603 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015605 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015607 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015608 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015609 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015611 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015612 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015613 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015614 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015615 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015616 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015617 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015618 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015619 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015620 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15621 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15622 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015623
15624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156257.1.1. Matching booleans
15626------------------------
15627
15628In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15629Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15630When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15631that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15632
15633Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15634return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15635"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15636
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156387.1.2. Matching integers
15639------------------------
15640
15641Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15642enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15643to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15644
15645Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15646matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15647lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015648
15649For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15650unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15651representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15652
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015653As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15654two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15655instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15656ranges and operators.
15657
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015658For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015659operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15660Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15661of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015662
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015663Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015664
15665 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15666 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15667 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15668 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15669 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15670
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015671For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015672
15673 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15674
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015675This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15676
15677 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15678
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156807.1.3. Matching strings
15681-----------------------
15682
15683String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15684different forms :
15685
15686 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015687 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015688
15689 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015690 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015691
15692 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15693 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15694
15695 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15696 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15697
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015698 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15700 matches.
15701
15702 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15703 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15704 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015705
15706String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15707exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15708characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15709string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15710to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015711before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015712
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015713Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15714(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15715Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15716
15717Example:
15718 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15719 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15720
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157227.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15723---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015724
15725Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15726they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15727possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15728passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15729the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015730the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15731match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015732
15733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157347.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15735-------------------------------------
15736
15737It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15738not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15739a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15740to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15741digits may be used upper or lower case.
15742
15743Example :
15744 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15745 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15746
15747
157487.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15749---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015750
15751IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15752netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15753within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015754host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015755difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15756at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15757does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15758parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015759
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015760The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15761abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15762
15763 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15764 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15765 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15766 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15767 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15768 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15769 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15770 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15771
15772Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15773192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15774
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015775IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15776Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15777trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15778IPv6 patterns.
15779
15780HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15781following situations :
15782 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15783 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15784 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15785 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15786 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15787 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15788 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15789 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15790 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15791 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015793
157947.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15795----------------------------------
15796
15797Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15798combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15799
15800 - AND (implicit)
15801 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15802 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015806 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015808Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15809indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015811For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15812"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15813requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15814is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15815
15816 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015817 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15818 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15819 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015820
15821To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15822and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15823
15824 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15825 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15826 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15827 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15828
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015829 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015830 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15831 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15832 use_backend www if host_www
15833
15834It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15835expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15836be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15837the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15838
15839 The following rule :
15840
15841 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015842 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015843
15844 Can also be written that way :
15845
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015846 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015847
15848It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15849to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15850simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15851sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15852good use is the following :
15853
15854 With named ACLs :
15855
15856 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15857 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15858 monitor fail if site_dead
15859
15860 With anonymous ACLs :
15861
15862 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15863
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015864See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15865keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015866
15867
158687.3. Fetching samples
15869---------------------
15870
15871Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15872against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15873sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15874ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15875of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15876available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15877
15878This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15879Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15880compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15881deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15882
15883The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15884matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15885method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15886indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15887
15888As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15889when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15890mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15891the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15892ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15893
15894Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15895multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15896when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015897incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15898are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015899is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15900all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15901
15902Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15903 - name
15904 - name(arg1)
15905 - name(arg1,arg2)
15906
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015907
159087.3.1. Converters
15909-----------------
15910
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015911Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15912of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15913is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15914was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015915has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015916unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15917
15918These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15919sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15920the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015921support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015922
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015923A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15924support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15925supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15926(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15927bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015929The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015930
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001593151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15932 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15933 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15934 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15935 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15936 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15937
15938 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015939 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15940 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015941 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15942 frontend http-in
15943 bind *:8081
15944 default_backend servers
15945 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15946 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15947
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015948add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015949 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015950 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015951 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15952 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015953 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015954 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15955 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15956 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15957 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015958 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015959 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015960
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015961aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15962 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15963 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15964 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15965 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15966 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15967 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15968
15969 Example:
15970 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15971 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15972
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015973and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015974 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015975 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015976 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15977 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015978 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015979 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15980 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15981 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15982 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015983 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015984 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015985
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015986b64dec
15987 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15988 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015989 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15990 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015991
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015992base64
15993 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015994 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015995 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15996 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015997
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015998bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015999 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016000 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016001 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016002 presence of a flag).
16003
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016004bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16005 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16006 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016007 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016008
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016009concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16010 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16011 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16012 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16013 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16014 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16015 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16016 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16017 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16018 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16019 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016020 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016021 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016022 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16023 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016024
16025 Example:
16026 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16027 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16028 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016029 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016030 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16031
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016032cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016033 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16034 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016035
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016036crc32([<avalanche>])
16037 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16038 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16039 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16040 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16041 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16042 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16043 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16044 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16045 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16046 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016047 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16048
16049crc32c([<avalanche>])
16050 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16051 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16052 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16053 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16054 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16055 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16056 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16057 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016058
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016059cut_crlf
16060 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16061 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16062 updated.
16063
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016064da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016065 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16066 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16067 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16068 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016069 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016070 configuration language.
16071
16072 Example:
16073 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016074 bind *:8881
16075 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016076 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016077
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016078debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16079 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16080 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16081 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16082 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16083 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16084 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16085 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16086 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16087 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16088 printable sample types.
16089
16090 Example:
16091 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016092
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016093digest(<algorithm>)
16094 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16095 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16096
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016097 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016098 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16099
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016100div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016101 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16102 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016103 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016104 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16105 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016106 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016107 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16108 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16109 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16110 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016111 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016112 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016113
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016114djb2([<avalanche>])
16115 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16116 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16117 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16118 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16119 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16120 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16121 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016122 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16123 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016124
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016125even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016126 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016127 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16128
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016129field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16130 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16131 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16132 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16133 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16134 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16135 fields.
16136
16137 Example :
16138 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16139 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16140 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16141 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16142 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016143
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016144fix_is_valid
16145 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16146 Information eXchange):
16147
16148 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16149 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016150 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016151 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016152 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016153 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16154 checksum
16155
16156 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16157 the server can be parsed.
16158
16159 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16160 message, false if not.
16161
16162 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16163
16164 Example:
16165 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16166 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16167
16168fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16169 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16170 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16171 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16172 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016173 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016174 added.
16175
16176 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16177 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16178 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16179 fix_is_valid converter.
16180
16181 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16182
16183 Example:
16184 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16185 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16186 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16187 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16188 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16189
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016190hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016191 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016192 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016193 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016194 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016195
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016196hex2i
16197 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016198 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016199
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016200htonl
16201 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16202 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16203 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16204 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16205
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016206hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016207 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16208 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16209 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16210 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16211
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016212 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016213 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16214
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016215http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016216 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16217 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016218 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16219 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16220 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16221 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16222 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16223 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16224 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16225 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016226
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016227iif(<true>,<false>)
16228 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16229 string otherwise.
16230
16231 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016232 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016233
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016234in_table(<table>)
16235 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16236 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16237 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016238 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016239 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16240
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016241ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016242 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016243 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016244 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16245 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16246 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16247 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16248 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016249
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016250json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016251 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016252 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016253 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016254 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16255 of errors:
16256 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16257 bytes, ...)
16258 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16259 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16260
16261 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16262 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16263 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16264 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16265 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16266 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016267 - "ascii" : never fails;
16268 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16269 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016270 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016271 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016272 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16273 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16274
16275 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016276 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016277
16278 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016279 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016280 capture request header user-agent len 150
16281 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016282
16283 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16284 GET / HTTP/1.0
16285 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16286
16287 Output log:
16288 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16289
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016290json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16291 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16292 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16293 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16294 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16295
16296 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16297 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16298
16299 Example:
16300 # get a integer value from the request body
16301 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16302 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16303
16304 # get a key with '.' in the name
16305 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16306 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16307
16308 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16309 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16310
16311 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16312 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16313
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016314language(<value>[,<default>])
16315 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16316 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16317 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16318 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16319 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16320 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16321 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16322 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16323 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016324 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016325 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16326 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016327
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016328 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016329
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016330 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16331 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016332
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016333 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16334 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16335 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16336 use_backend spanish if es
16337 use_backend french if fr
16338 use_backend english if en
16339 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016340
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016341length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016342 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16343 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16344 type. The result is of type integer.
16345
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016346lower
16347 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16348 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16349 type. The result is of type string.
16350
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016351ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16352 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16353 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16354 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16355 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16356 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16357 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16358
16359 Example :
16360
16361 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016362 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016363 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16364
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016365ltrim(<chars>)
16366 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16367 representation of the input sample.
16368
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016369map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16370map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16371map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16372 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16373 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16374 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16375 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16376 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16377 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16378 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16379 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016380
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016381 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16382 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16383 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016384
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016385 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016386 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016387
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016388 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16389 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16390 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16391 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016392 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16393 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016394 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16395 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16396 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16397 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16398 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16399 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16400 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16401 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016402 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16403 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16404 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016405 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16406 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16407 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16408 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16409 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016410
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016411 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16412 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16413 the corresponding match text.
16414
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016415 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16416 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16417 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16418 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16419 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016420
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016421 Example :
16422
16423 # this is a comment and is ignored
16424 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16425 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16426 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16427 | | | `---------- value
16428 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16429 | `---------------------------- key
16430 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16431
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016432mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016433 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16434 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016435 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016436 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016437 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016438 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16439 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16440 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16441 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016442 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016443 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016444
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016445mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016446 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16447 <packettype>.
16448 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16449 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16450 from.
16451 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16452 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16453 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16454
16455 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16456 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16457 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16458 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16459
16460 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16461 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16462 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16463 packets only):
16464 17: Session Expiry Interval
16465 33: Receive Maximum
16466 39: Maximum Packet Size
16467 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16468 25: Request Response Information
16469 23: Request Problem Information
16470 21: Authentication Method
16471 22: Authentication Data
16472 18: Will Delay Interval
16473 1: Payload Format Indicator
16474 2: Message Expiry Interval
16475 3: Content Type
16476 8: Response Topic
16477 9: Correlation Data
16478 Not supported yet:
16479 38: User Property
16480
16481 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16482 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16483 packets only):
16484 17: Session Expiry Interval
16485 33: Receive Maximum
16486 36: Maximum QoS
16487 37: Retain Available
16488 39: Maximum Packet Size
16489 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16490 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16491 31: Reason String
16492 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16493 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16494 42: Shared Subscription Available
16495 19: Server Keep Alive
16496 26: Response Information
16497 28: Server Reference
16498 21: Authentication Method
16499 22: Authentication Data
16500 Not supported yet:
16501 38: User Property
16502
16503 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16504 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16505 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16506 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16507
16508 Example:
16509
16510 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16511 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16512 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16513 if data_in_buffer
16514 # do the same as above
16515 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16516 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16517 if data_in_buffer
16518
16519mqtt_is_valid
16520 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16521
16522 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16523 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16524 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16525 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16526
16527 Example:
16528
16529 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016530 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016531
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016532mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016533 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016534 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16535 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016536 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016537 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016538 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016539 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16540 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16541 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16542 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016543 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016544 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016545
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016546nbsrv
16547 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16548 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16549 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16550 map lookup.
16551
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016552neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016553 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16554 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16555 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16556 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016557
16558not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016559 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016560 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016561 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016562 absence of a flag).
16563
16564odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016565 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016566 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16567
16568or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016569 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016570 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016571 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16572 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016573 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016574 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16575 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16576 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16577 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016578 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016579 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016580
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016581protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16582 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16583 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16584 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16585 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16586 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16587 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16588 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16589 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16590 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16591 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16592 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16593
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016594regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016595 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16596 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16597 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16598 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16599 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16600 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16601 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16602 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16603 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016604 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16605 of characters with other ones.
16606
16607 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16608 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16609 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16610 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16611 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16612 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016613
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016614 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016615
16616 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16617 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16618 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016619 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016620
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016621 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16622 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16623
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016624 # capture groups and backreferences
16625 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016626 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016627 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16628
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016629capture-req(<id>)
16630 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16631 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16632
16633 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016634 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16635 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016636
16637capture-res(<id>)
16638 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16639 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16640
16641 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016642 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16643 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016644
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016645rtrim(<chars>)
16646 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16647 of the input sample.
16648
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016649sdbm([<avalanche>])
16650 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16651 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16652 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16653 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16654 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16655 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16656 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016657 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16658 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016659
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016660secure_memcmp(<var>)
16661 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16662 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16663 match.
16664
16665 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16666 performed in constant time.
16667
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016668 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016669 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16670
16671 Example :
16672
16673 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16674 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16675 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16676 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16677
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016678set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016679 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16680 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16681 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016682 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016683 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16684 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016685 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016686 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16687 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016688 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016689 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016690
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016691sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016692 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016693 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16694
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016695sha2([<bits>])
16696 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16697 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16698
16699 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16700 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16701
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016702 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016703 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16704
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016705srv_queue
16706 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16707 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16708 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16709 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16710 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16711
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016712strcmp(<var>)
16713 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16714 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16715 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16716 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16717 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16718 shorter).
16719
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016720 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16721 strings in constant time.
16722
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016723 Example :
16724
16725 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16726 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16727 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16728
16729
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016730sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016731 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16732 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016733 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016734 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16735 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016736 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016737 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16738 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016739 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016740 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16741 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016742 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016743 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016744
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016745table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16746 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16747 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16748 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16749 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16750 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16751 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16752
16753
16754table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16755 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16756 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16757 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16758 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16759 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16760 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16761
16762table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16763 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16764 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016765 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016766 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16767 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16768
16769table_conn_cur(<table>)
16770 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16771 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16772 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16773 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16774 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16775
16776table_conn_rate(<table>)
16777 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16778 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16779 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16780 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16781 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16782
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016783table_gpt0(<table>)
16784 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16785 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16786 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16787 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16788 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16789
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016790table_gpc0(<table>)
16791 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16792 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16793 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16794 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16795 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16796
16797table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16798 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16799 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16800 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16801 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16802 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16803 sample fetch keyword.
16804
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016805table_gpc1(<table>)
16806 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16807 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16808 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16809 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16810 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16811
16812table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16813 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16814 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16815 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16816 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16817 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16818 sample fetch keyword.
16819
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016820table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16821 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16822 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016823 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016824 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16825 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16826
16827table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16828 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16829 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16830 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16831 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16832 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16833 keyword.
16834
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016835table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16836 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16837 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16838 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16839 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16840 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16841
16842table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16843 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16844 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16845 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16846 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16847 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16848 keyword.
16849
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016850table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16851 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16852 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016853 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016854 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16855 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16856
16857table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16858 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16859 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16860 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16861 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16862 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16863 keyword.
16864
16865table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16866 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16867 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016868 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016869 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16870 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16871 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16872 keyword.
16873
16874table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16875 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16876 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016877 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016878 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16879 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16880 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16881 keyword.
16882
16883table_server_id(<table>)
16884 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16885 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16886 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16887 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16888 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16889 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16890
16891table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16892 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16893 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016894 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016895 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16896 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16897 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16898 keyword.
16899
16900table_sess_rate(<table>)
16901 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16902 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16903 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16904 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16905 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16906 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16907 keyword.
16908
16909table_trackers(<table>)
16910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16912 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16913 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16914 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16915 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16916 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16917 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16918 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16919 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16920
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016921ub64dec
16922 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16923 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16924 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16925
16926 Example:
16927 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16928 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16929
16930ub64enc
16931 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16932
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016933upper
16934 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16935 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16936 type. The result is of type string.
16937
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016938url_dec([<in_form>])
16939 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16940 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16941 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16942 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16943 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16944 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016945
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016946url_enc([<enc_type>])
16947 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16948 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16949 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16950 optional argument is here for future changes.
16951
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016952ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016953 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016954 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16955 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16956 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016957 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16958 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16959 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16960 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016961 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016962 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16963 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016964
16965 Example:
16966 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16967 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16968
16969 message Point {
16970 int32 latitude = 1;
16971 int32 longitude = 2;
16972 }
16973
16974 message PPoint {
16975 Point point = 59;
16976 }
16977
16978 message Rectangle {
16979 // One corner of the rectangle.
16980 PPoint lo = 48;
16981 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16982 PPoint hi = 49;
16983 }
16984
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016985 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16986 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16987 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016988
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016989 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16990 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016991 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016992 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16993
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016994 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016995
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016996 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016997
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016998 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16999 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17000 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017001
17002 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17003 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17004 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17005
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017006 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17007 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17008 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017009
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017010
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017011unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017012 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17013 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17014 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17015 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17016 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17017 response),
17018 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17019 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17020 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17021 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17022
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017023utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17024 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17025 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17026 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17027 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17028 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17029 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17030
17031 Example :
17032
17033 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017034 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017035 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17036
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017037word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17038 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17039 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17040 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017041 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017042 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17043 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17044
17045 Example :
17046 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17047 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17048 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17049 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17050 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017051 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017052
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017053wt6([<avalanche>])
17054 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17055 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17056 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17057 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17058 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17059 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17060 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017061 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17062 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017063
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017064xor(<value>)
17065 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017066 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017067 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017068 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017069 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017070 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17071 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017072 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017073 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17074 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017075 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017076 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017077
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017078xxh3([<seed>])
17079 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17080 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17081 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17082 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17083 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17084 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17085 considered as cryptographically secure.
17086
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017087xxh32([<seed>])
17088 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17089 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17090 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17091 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17092 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17093 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17094 as cryptographically secure.
17095
17096xxh64([<seed>])
17097 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17098 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17099 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17100 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17101 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17102 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17103 as cryptographically secure.
17104
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017105
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200171067.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017107--------------------------------------------
17108
17109A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17110not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17111"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17112The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17113
17114always_false : boolean
17115 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17116 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17117
17118always_true : boolean
17119 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17120 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17121
17122avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017123 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017124 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17125 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17126 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17127 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17128 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17129 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17130 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17131 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17132 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17133 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17134 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17135 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17136 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017138be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017139 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17140 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17141 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17142 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017143 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17144
17145be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17146 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17147 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17148 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17149 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17150 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017151 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17152 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017153
17154 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17155 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17156 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017158be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17159 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17160 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17161 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017162 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017163 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17164 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017165
17166 Example :
17167 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17168 backend dynamic
17169 mode http
17170 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17171 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017172
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017173bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017174 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17175 of the string.
17176
17177bool(<bool>) : bool
17178 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17179 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017181connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17182 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017183 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017184 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17185 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017186
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017187 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017188 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017189 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17190
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017191 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17192 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017193
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017194 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017195 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017196 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017197 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017198 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017199 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017200 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017201
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017202 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17203 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017204 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017205 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017206
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017207cpu_calls : integer
17208 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17209 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17210 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17211 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17212 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17213 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17214
17215cpu_ns_avg : integer
17216 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17217 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17218 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17219 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17220 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17221 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17222 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17223 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17224 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17225 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17226 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17227
17228cpu_ns_tot : integer
17229 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17230 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17231 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17232 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17233 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17234 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17235 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17236 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17237 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17238 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17239 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17240 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17241 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17242
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017243date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017244 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017245
17246 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17247 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17248 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017249 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17250
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017251 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17252 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17253 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17254 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17255 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17256
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017257 Example :
17258
17259 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17260 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017261
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017262 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17263 # millisecond granularity
17264 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17265
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017266date_us : integer
17267 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17268 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17269 from the same timeval structure.
17270
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017271distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17272 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17273 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17274 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17275 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017276 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017277 list of supported tokens.
17278
17279distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17280 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17281 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17282 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17283 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017284 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017285 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17286 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17287 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17288 supported tokens.
17289
17290 Example :
17291 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17292 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17293 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17294 # send large files to the big farm
17295 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17296
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017297env(<name>) : string
17298 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17299 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17300 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17301 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17302 certain way.
17303
17304 Examples :
17305 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17306 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17307
17308 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17309 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017311fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17312 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017313 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17314 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017315 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17316 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017317 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017318 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17319 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017320
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017321fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17322 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17323 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17324 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017326fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17327 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17328 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17329 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17330 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17331 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17332 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17333 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17334 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017335
17336 Example :
17337 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17338 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17339 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17340 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17341 frontend mail
17342 bind :25
17343 mode tcp
17344 maxconn 100
17345 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17346 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17347 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17348 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017349
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017350hostname : string
17351 Returns the system hostname.
17352
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017353int(<integer>) : signed integer
17354 Returns a signed integer.
17355
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017356ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17357 Returns an ipv4.
17358
17359ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17360 Returns an ipv6.
17361
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017362lat_ns_avg : integer
17363 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17364 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17365 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17366 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17367 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17368 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17369 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17370 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17371 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017372 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17373 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17374 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17375 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17376 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17377 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017378
17379lat_ns_tot : integer
17380 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17381 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17382 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17383 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17384 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17385 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17386 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17387 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17388 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017389 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17390 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17391 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17392 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17393 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017394 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17395 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17396 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17397 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17398 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17399 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17400
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017401meth(<method>) : method
17402 Returns a method.
17403
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017404nbproc : integer
17405 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17406 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17407 and debugging purposes.
17408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017409nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17410 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17411 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17412 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017413 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17414 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17415 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017416
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017417prio_class : integer
17418 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17419 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17420 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17421
17422prio_offset : integer
17423 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17424 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17425 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17426 set-priority-offset".
17427
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017428proc : integer
17429 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17430 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17431 debugging purposes.
17432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017433queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017434 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17435 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17436 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017437 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17438 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17439 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17440 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17441 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17442
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017443rand([<range>]) : integer
17444 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17445 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17446 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17447 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17448 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017450srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17451 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17452 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17453 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17454 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17455 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017456 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17457 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17458
17459srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17460 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17461 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17462 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17463 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17464 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17465 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17466 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17467
17468 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17469 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017470
17471srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17472 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17473 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17474 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017475 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017476 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17477 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17478 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17479
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017480srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17481 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17482 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17483 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17484 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17485 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17486 fetch methods.
17487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017488srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17489 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17490 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017491 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017492 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17493 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017494 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017495 overloading servers).
17496
17497 Example :
17498 # Redirect to a separate back
17499 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17500 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17501 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17502
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017503srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017504 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17505 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17506 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17507
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017508srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017509 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17510 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17511 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17512
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017513srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017514 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17515 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17516 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17517
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017518stopping : boolean
17519 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17520 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17521 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17522
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017523str(<string>) : string
17524 Returns a string.
17525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017526table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17527 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17528 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17529
17530table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17531 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17532 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17533 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17534
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017535thread : integer
17536 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17537 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17538 and debugging purposes.
17539
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017540uuid([<version>]) : string
17541 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17542 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17543 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17544
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017545var(<var-name>) : undefined
17546 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017547 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17548 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017549 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017550 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17551 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017552 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017553 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17554 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017555 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017556 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017557
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175587.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017559----------------------------------
17560
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017561The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017562closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17563methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17564sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17565TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017566the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17567counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017568"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17569used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17570can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17571Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17572table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17573tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17574currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017575
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017576bc_dst : ip
17577 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17578 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17579 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17580 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17581
17582bc_dst_port : integer
17583 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017584 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017585
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017586bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017587 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17588 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17589 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17590
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017591bc_src : ip
17592 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017593 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017594 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17595 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17596
17597bc_src_port : integer
17598 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017599 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017601be_id : integer
17602 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017603 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17604 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017605
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017606be_name : string
17607 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017608 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17609 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017610
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017611be_server_timeout : integer
17612 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17613 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17614 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17615
17616be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17617 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17618 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17619 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17620
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017621cur_server_timeout : integer
17622 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17623 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17624 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17625
17626cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17627 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17628 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17629 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017631dst : ip
17632 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17633 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17634 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17635 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017636 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17637 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17638 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17639 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17640 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17641 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017642
17643dst_conn : integer
17644 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17645 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17646 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17647 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17648 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17649 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17650 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17651 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017652
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017653dst_is_local : boolean
17654 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17655 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17656 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17657 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017658 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017659 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17660 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17661 it only once per connection.
17662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017663dst_port : integer
17664 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17665 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17666 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17667 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17668 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17669 an HTTP header.
17670
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017671fc_http_major : integer
17672 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17673 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17674 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17675
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017676fc_pp_authority : string
17677 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17678 if any.
17679
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017680fc_pp_unique_id : string
17681 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17682 if any.
17683
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017684fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17685 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17686 header.
17687
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017688fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17689 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17690 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17691 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17692 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17693 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17694 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17695
17696fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17697 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17698 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17699 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17700 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17701 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17702 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17703
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017704fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017705 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17706 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17707 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17708 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17709
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017710fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017711 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17712 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17713 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17714 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17715
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017716fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017717 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17718 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17719 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17720 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17721
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017722fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017723 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17724 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17725 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17726 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17727
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017728fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017729 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17730 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17731 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17732 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17733
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017734fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017735 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17736 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17737 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17738 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17739
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017740fe_defbe : string
17741 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17742 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017744fe_id : integer
17745 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017746 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017747 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17748
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017749fe_name : string
17750 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17751 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17752 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17753
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017754fe_client_timeout : integer
17755 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17756 current frontend.
17757
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017758sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017759sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17760sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17761sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017762 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17763 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17764 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17765
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017766sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017767sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17768sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17769sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017770 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17771 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17772 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17773
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017774sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017775sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17776sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17777sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017778 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17779 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017780 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17781 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17782 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017783
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017784 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017785 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17786 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017787 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17788 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17789 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017790 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17791 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17792
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017793sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17794sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17795sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17796sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17797 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17798 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17799 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17800 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17801 when a first ACL was verified.
17802
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017803sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017804sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17805sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17806sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017807 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017808 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17809
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017810sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017811sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17812sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17813sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017814 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17815 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17816 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17817
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017818sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017819sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17820sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17821sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017822 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17823 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17824 See also src_conn_rate.
17825
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017826sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017827sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17828sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17829sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017830 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017831 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017832
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017833sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17834sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17835sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17836sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17837 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17838 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17839
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017840sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17841sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17842sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17843sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17844 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17845 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17846
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017847sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017848sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17849sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17850sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017851 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17852 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17853 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017854 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17855 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17856 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017857
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017858sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17859sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17860sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17861sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17862 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17863 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17864 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17865 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17866 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17867 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17868
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017869sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017870sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17871sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17872sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017873 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017874 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17875 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17876
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017877sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017878sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17879sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17880sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017881 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17882 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17883 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17884 src_http_err_rate.
17885
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017886sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17887sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17888sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17889sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17890 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17891 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17892 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17893
17894sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17895sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17896sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17897sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17898 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17899 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17900 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17901 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17902
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017903sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017904sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17905sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17906sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017907 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017908 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17909 src_http_req_cnt.
17910
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017911sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017912sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17913sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17914sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017915 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17916 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17917 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17918 src_http_req_rate.
17919
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017920sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017921sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17922sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17923sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017924 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017925 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17926 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17927 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17928 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017929
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017930 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017931 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17932 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017933 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17934
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017935sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17936sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17937sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17938sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17939 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17940 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17941 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17942 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17943 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17944
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017945sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017946sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17947sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17948sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017949 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17950 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17951 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017952
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017953sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017954sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17955sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17956sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017957 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17958 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17959 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017960
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017961sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017962sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17963sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17964sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017965 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017966 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17967 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17968 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017969 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017970 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17971
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017972sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017973sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17974sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17975sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017976 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17977 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17978 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17979 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17980 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017981 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017982
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017983sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017984sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17985sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17986sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017987 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17988 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17989 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17990
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017991sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017992sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17993sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17994sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017995 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17996 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017997 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017998 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17999 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018000 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18001 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18002 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018004so_id : integer
18005 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18006 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18007 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018008
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018009so_name : string
18010 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18011 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18012 strings instead of integers.
18013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018014src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018015 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018016 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18017 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18018 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018019 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18020 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18021 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018022 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18023 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18024 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18025 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18026 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18027 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18028 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018029
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018030 Example:
18031 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18032 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018034src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18035 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18036 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18037 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018038 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018040src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18041 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18042 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018043 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018044 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018046src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18047 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18048 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18049 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18050 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18051 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18052 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018053
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018054 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018055 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18056 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18057 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18058 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018059 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018060 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18061 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18062
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018063src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18064 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18065 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18066 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18067 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18068 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18069 was verified.
18070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018071src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018072 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018073 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018074 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018075 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018077src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018078 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018079 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18080 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018081 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018083src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18084 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18085 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18086 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018087 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018089src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018090 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018091 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018092 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018093 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018094
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018095src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18096 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18097 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18098 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18099 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18100
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018101src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18102 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18103 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18104 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18105 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018107src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018108 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018109 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018110 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18111 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018112 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18113 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18114 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018115
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018116src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18117 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18118 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18119 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18120 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18121 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18122 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18123 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018125src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018126 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018127 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018128 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018129 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018130 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018132src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18133 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18134 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18135 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18136 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018137 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018138
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018139src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18140 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18141 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018142 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018143 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18144 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18145
18146src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18147 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18148 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18149 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18150 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18151 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18152 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018154src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018155 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018156 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18157 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018158 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018160src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18161 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18162 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18163 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018164 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018165 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018167src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18168 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18169 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18170 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018171 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018172 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18173 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018174
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018175 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018176 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018177 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018178 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018179
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018180src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18181 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18182 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18183 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18184 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18185 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18186 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18187
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018188src_is_local : boolean
18189 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18190 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18191 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18192 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018193 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018194 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18195 once per connection.
18196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018197src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018198 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18199 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18200 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18201 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18202 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018204src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018205 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18206 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18207 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18208 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18209 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018211src_port : integer
18212 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18213 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18214 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18215 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018217src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018218 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018219 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18220 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18221 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018222 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018224src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18225 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18226 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18227 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18228 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018229 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018231src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18232 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18233 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18234 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18235 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18236 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18237 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18238 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18239 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018240
18241 Example :
18242 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18243 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18244 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18245 listen ssh
18246 bind :22
18247 mode tcp
18248 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018249 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018250 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018251 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018253srv_id : integer
18254 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18255 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018256 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018257
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018258srv_name : string
18259 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18260 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018261 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018262
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182637.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018264----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018265
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018266The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018267closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18268when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18269usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018270future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018271
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001827251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18273 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18274 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18275 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18276 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18277 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18278
18279 Example :
18280 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18281 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18282 # the request.
18283 frontend http-in
18284 bind *:8081
18285 default_backend servers
18286 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18287 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18288
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018289ssl_bc : boolean
18290 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18291 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018292 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18293 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018294
18295ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18296 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018297 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18298 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018299
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018300ssl_bc_alpn : string
18301 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18302 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018303 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018304 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18305 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18306 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18307 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18308 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018309 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18310 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018311
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018312ssl_bc_cipher : string
18313 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018314 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18315 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018316
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018317ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18318 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18319 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18320 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018321 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018322
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018323ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18324 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18325 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018326 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18327 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018328
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018329ssl_bc_npn : string
18330 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18331 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018332 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018333 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18334 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18335 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18336 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018337 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18338 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018339
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018340ssl_bc_protocol : string
18341 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018342 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18343 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018344
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018345ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018346 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018347 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018348 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18349 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018350
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018351ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18352 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18353 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18354 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018355 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018356
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018357ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18358 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18359 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018360 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18361 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018362
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018363ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18364 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18365 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18366 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018367 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018368
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018369ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18370 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018371 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18372 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018374ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18375 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18376 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18377 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18378 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18379 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018381ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18382 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18383 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18384 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18385 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018386
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018387ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018388 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18389 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18390 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018391 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018392 does not support resumed sessions.
18393
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018394ssl_c_der : binary
18395 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18396 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18397 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018399ssl_c_err : integer
18400 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18401 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18402 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18403 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18404 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018405
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018406ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018407 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18408 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18409 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18410 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18411 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18412 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18413 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18414 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018415 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18416 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18417 LDAP v3.
18418 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18419 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018421ssl_c_key_alg : string
18422 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18423 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18424 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018426ssl_c_notafter : string
18427 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18428 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18429 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018431ssl_c_notbefore : string
18432 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18433 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18434 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018435
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018436ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018437 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18438 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18439 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18440 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18441 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18442 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18443 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18444 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018445 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18446 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18447 LDAP v3.
18448 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18449 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018451ssl_c_serial : binary
18452 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18453 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18454 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018456ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18457 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18458 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18459 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018460 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18461 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18462
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018463 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018464 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018466ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18467 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18468 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18469 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018471ssl_c_used : boolean
18472 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18473 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018475ssl_c_verify : integer
18476 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18477 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18478 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18479 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018481ssl_c_version : integer
18482 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18483 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018484
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018485ssl_f_der : binary
18486 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18487 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18488 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18489
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018490ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018491 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18492 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18493 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18494 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018495 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018496 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18497 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18498 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018499 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18500 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18501 LDAP v3.
18502 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18503 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018505ssl_f_key_alg : string
18506 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18507 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18508 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018510ssl_f_notafter : string
18511 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18512 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18513 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018515ssl_f_notbefore : string
18516 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18517 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18518 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018519
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018520ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018521 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18522 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18523 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18524 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18525 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18526 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18527 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18528 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018529 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18530 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18531 LDAP v3.
18532 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18533 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018535ssl_f_serial : binary
18536 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18537 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18538 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018539
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018540ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18541 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18542 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18543 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018545ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18546 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18547 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18548 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018550ssl_f_version : integer
18551 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18552 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18553
18554ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018555 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18556 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18557 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018559 Example :
18560 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18561 listen http-https
18562 bind :80
18563 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18564 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18565
18566ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18567 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18568 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18569
18570ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018571 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018572 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018573 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018574 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18575 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18576 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18577 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18578 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18579 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018581ssl_fc_cipher : string
18582 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18583 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018584
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018585ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18586 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18587 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018588 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018589
18590ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18591 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18592 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018593 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018594
18595ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18596 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18597 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18598 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018599 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018600 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018601
18602ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18603 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18604 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018605 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018606
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018607ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18608 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18609 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18610 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18611
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018612ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18613 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18614 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18615 transport layer.
18616 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18617 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18618 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18619 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18620
18621ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18622 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18623 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18624 transport layer.
18625 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18626 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18627 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18628 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18629
18630ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18631 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18632 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18633 transport layer.
18634 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18635 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18636 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18637 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18638
18639ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18640 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18641 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18642 transport layer.
18643 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18644 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18645 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18646 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18647
18648ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18649 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18650 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18651 transport layer.
18652 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18653 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18654 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18655 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018657ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018658 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18659 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018660 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18661 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18662 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18663 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018664
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018665ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18666 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18667 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18668 wait until the handshake happened.
18669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018670ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18671 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018672 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18673 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018674 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018675 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018676
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018677ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018678 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018679 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18680 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018682ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018683 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018684 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018685 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18686 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18687 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18688 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18689 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18690 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018692ssl_fc_protocol : string
18693 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18694 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018695
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018696ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018697 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018698 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18699 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018700
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018701ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18702 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18703 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18704 transport layer.
18705 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18706 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18707 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18708 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18709
18710ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18711 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18712 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18713 transport layer.
18714 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18715 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18716 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18717 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18718
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018719ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18720 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18721 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18722 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018724ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18725 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18726 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18727 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18728 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018729
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018730ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18731 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18732 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18733 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18734 BoringSSL.
18735
18736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018737ssl_fc_sni : string
18738 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18739 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018740 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018741 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18742 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18743
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018744 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018745 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018746 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018747 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018748 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018750 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018751 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18752 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018754ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18755 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18756 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018757
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018758ssl_s_der : binary
18759 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18760 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18761 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18762
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018763ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18764 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18765 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18766 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018767 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018768 does not support resumed sessions.
18769
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018770ssl_s_key_alg : string
18771 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18772 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18773 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18774
18775ssl_s_notafter : string
18776 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18777 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18778 transport layer.
18779
18780ssl_s_notbefore : string
18781 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18782 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18783 transport layer.
18784
18785ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18786 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18787 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18788 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18789 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18790 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18791 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018792 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18793 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018794 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18795 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18796 LDAP v3.
18797 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18798 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18799
18800ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18801 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18802 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18803 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18804 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18805 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18806 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018807 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18808 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018809 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18810 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18811 LDAP v3.
18812 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18813 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18814
18815ssl_s_serial : binary
18816 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18817 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18818 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18819
18820ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18821 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18822 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18823 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18824
18825ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18826 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18827 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18828 layer.
18829
18830ssl_s_version : integer
18831 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18832 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018833
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200188347.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018835------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018837Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18838sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18839only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18840For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18841be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18842can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18843sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18844for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18845content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018846
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018847Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18848 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018849 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018850 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18851 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18852 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18853 sample expression). So be careful.
18854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018855payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018856 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018857 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18858 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018860payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18861 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018862 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018863 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018865req.len : integer
18866req_len : integer (deprecated)
18867 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18868 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18869 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18870 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18871 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018872 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018873 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18874 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018876req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18877 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018878 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18879 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18880 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18881 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018883 ACL alternatives :
18884 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018886req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18887 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18888 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18889 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18890 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018892 ACL alternatives :
18893 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018895 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018897req.proto_http : boolean
18898req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18899 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18900 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18901 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18902 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18903 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18904 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18905 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018907 Example:
18908 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18909 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18910 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018911 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018913req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18914rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18915 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18916 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18917 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18918 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18919 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18920 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18921 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018923 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18924 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18925 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18926 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18927 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18928 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018930 ACL derivatives :
18931 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018933 Example :
18934 listen tse-farm
18935 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18936 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18937 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18938 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18939 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18940 persist rdp-cookie
18941 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18942 # This is only useful makes sense if
18943 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18944 stick-table type string size 204800
18945 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18946 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18947 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018949 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18950 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018952req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18953rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18954 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18955 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18956 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18957 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018959 ACL derivatives :
18960 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018961
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018962req.ssl_alpn : string
18963 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18964 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18965 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18966 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18967 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18968 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018969 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018970
18971 Examples :
18972 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18973 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18974 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018975 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018976 default_backend bk_default
18977
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018978req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18979 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18980 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018981 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18982 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18983 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18984 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18985 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018987req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18988req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18989 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18990 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18991 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18992 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18993 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18994 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18995 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018997req.ssl_sni : string
18998req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18999 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19000 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19001 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19002 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19003 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019004 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19005 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19006 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19007 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19008 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19009 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19010 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19011 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19012 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019014 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019015 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019017 Examples :
19018 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19019 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19020 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019021 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019022 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019023
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019024req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19025 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19026 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19027 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19028 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19029 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19030 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19031 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19032 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19033 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019035req.ssl_ver : integer
19036req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19037 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19038 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19039 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19040 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19041 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19042 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19043 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019044 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019045 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019047 ACL derivatives :
19048 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019049
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019050res.len : integer
19051 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19052 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19053 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19054 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19055 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019056 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019057 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019058 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019060res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19061 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019062 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019063 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019064 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019065 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019067res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19068 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19069 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19070 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019071 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19072 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019074 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019075
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019076res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19077rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19078 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19079 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19080 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19081 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19082 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19083 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19084 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019086wait_end : boolean
19087 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19088 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019089 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019090 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19091 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019092 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019093 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19094 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019096 Examples :
19097 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19098 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19099 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019101 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19102 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19103 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19104 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19105 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19106 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19107 tcp-request content reject
19108
19109
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200191107.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019111--------------------------------------
19112
19113It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19114This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19115data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19116its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19117HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19118content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19119to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19120more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19121response are indexed.
19122
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019123Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19124 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19125 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19126 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19127 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19128 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19129 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019131base : string
19132 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19133 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19134 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19135 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19136 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19137 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19138 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19139 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19140
19141 ACL derivatives :
19142 base : exact string match
19143 base_beg : prefix match
19144 base_dir : subdir match
19145 base_dom : domain match
19146 base_end : suffix match
19147 base_len : length match
19148 base_reg : regex match
19149 base_sub : substring match
19150
19151base32 : integer
19152 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19153 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19154 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019155 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19156 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19157 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019158
19159base32+src : binary
19160 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19161 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19162 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19163 per-URL counters.
19164
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019165baseq : string
19166 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19167 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19168 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19169 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19170
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019171capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19172 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19173 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19174 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19175
19176capture.req.method : string
19177 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19178 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19179 because it's allocated.
19180
19181capture.req.uri : string
19182 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19183 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19184 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19185 allocated.
19186
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019187capture.req.ver : string
19188 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19189 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19190 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19191
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019192capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19193 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19194 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19195 The first entry is an index of 0.
19196 See also: "capture response header"
19197
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019198capture.res.ver : string
19199 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19200 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19201 persistent flag.
19202
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019203req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019204 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19205 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19206 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019207
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019208req.body_param([<name>) : string
19209 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19210 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19211 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19212 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19213 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19214 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19215 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19216 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19217 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19218 given.
19219
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019220req.body_len : integer
19221 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19222 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019223 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19224 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019225
19226req.body_size : integer
19227 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019228 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19229 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019231req.cook([<name>]) : string
19232cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19233 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19234 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19235 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19236 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19237 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19238 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19239 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19240 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19241
19242 ACL derivatives :
19243 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19244 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19245 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19246 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19247 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19248 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19249 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19250 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019252req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19253cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19254 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19255 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019257req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19258cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19259 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19260 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19261 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19262 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019264cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19265 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19266 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19267 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19268 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019269 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019270 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19271 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19272 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19273 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019275hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19276 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19277 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19278 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19279 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019280 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019282req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019283 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19284 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19285 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19286 with headers such as User-Agent.
19287
19288 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19289 found.
19290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019291 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19292 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19293 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019294 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019296req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19297 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19298 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019299 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19300 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019302req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019303 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19304 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19305 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19306 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19307 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19308 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19309 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19310
19311 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19312 found.
19313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019314 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19315 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19316 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019317 with -1 being the last one.
19318
19319 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19320 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019322 ACL derivatives :
19323 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19324 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19325 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19326 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19327 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19328 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19329 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19330 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19331
19332req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19333hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19334 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19335 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019336 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19337 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19338 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19339
19340 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19341 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19342 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19343
19344 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019345
19346req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19347hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19348 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19349 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19350 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019351 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19352 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19353 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19354 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19355 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019356
19357 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19358
19359 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019360
19361req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19362hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19363 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19364 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19365 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019366
19367 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19368
19369 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019370
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019371req.hdrs : string
19372 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19373 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19374 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19375 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19376
19377req.hdrs_bin : binary
19378 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19379 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19380 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19381 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19382 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19383 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19384
19385 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019386
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019387 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19388 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019390http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19391 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19392 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19393 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19394 basic auth is supported.
19395
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019396http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19397 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19398 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19399 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19400 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019401 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19402 basic auth is supported.
19403
19404 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019405 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19406 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19407 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19408 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019409
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019410http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019411 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19412 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19413 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019414
19415http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019416 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19417 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19418 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019419
19420http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019421 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19422 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19423 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019425http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019426 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19427 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019428 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19429 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019431method : integer + string
19432 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19433 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19434 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19435 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19436 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19437 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19438 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019440 ACL derivatives :
19441 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019443 Example :
19444 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19445 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19446 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019448path : string
19449 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19450 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19451 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19452 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19453 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019454 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019455 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019457 ACL derivatives :
19458 path : exact string match
19459 path_beg : prefix match
19460 path_dir : subdir match
19461 path_dom : domain match
19462 path_end : suffix match
19463 path_len : length match
19464 path_reg : regex match
19465 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019466
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019467pathq : string
19468 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19469 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19470 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19471 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19472 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19473 result in both cases.
19474
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019475query : string
19476 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19477 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19478 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19479 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019480 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019481 which stops before the question mark.
19482
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019483req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19484 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19485 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19486 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19487 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019489req.ver : string
19490req_ver : string (deprecated)
19491 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19492 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19493 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019495 ACL derivatives :
19496 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019497
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019498res.body : binary
19499 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19500 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019501 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19502
19503 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019504
19505res.body_len : integer
19506 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19507 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019508 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19509
19510 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019511
19512res.body_size : integer
19513 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19514 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19515 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19516 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019517 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19518
19519 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019520
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019521res.cache_hit : boolean
19522 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19523 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19524
19525res.cache_name : string
19526 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19527 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19528 empty string.
19529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019530res.comp : boolean
19531 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19532 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19533 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019535res.comp_algo : string
19536 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19537 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19538 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019540res.cook([<name>]) : string
19541scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19542 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19543 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019544 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19545
19546 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019548 ACL derivatives :
19549 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019551res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19552scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19553 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19554 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019555 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19556
19557 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019559res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19560scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19561 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19562 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019563 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19564
19565 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019567res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019568 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19569 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19570
19571 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19572 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19573
19574 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19575
19576 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019578res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019579 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19580 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19581
19582 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19583 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19584
19585 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019587res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19588shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019589 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19590 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19591
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019592 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019593 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19594
19595 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019597 ACL derivatives :
19598 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19599 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19600 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19601 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19602 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19603 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19604 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19605 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19606
19607res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19608shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019609 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19610 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19611
19612 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019613 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019614
19615 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019617res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19618shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019619 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19620 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19621
19622 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19623
19624 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019625
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019626res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19627 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19628 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19629 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019630 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19631
19632 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019634res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19635shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019636 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19637 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19638
19639 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19640
19641 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019642
19643res.hdrs : string
19644 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19645 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19646 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019647 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19648
19649 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019650
19651res.hdrs_bin : binary
19652 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19653 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19654 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19655 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19656 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19657 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19658 (length of 0 for both).
19659
19660 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19661
19662 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19663 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019665res.ver : string
19666resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19667 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019668 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19669
19670 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019672 ACL derivatives :
19673 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019675set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19676 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19677 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019678 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019679 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019681 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19682 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019684status : integer
19685 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19686 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019687 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19688
19689 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019690
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019691unique-id : string
19692 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19693 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19694 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19695 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19696 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19697 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019699url : string
19700 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19701 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19702 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19703 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19704 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19705 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19706 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019708 ACL derivatives :
19709 url : exact string match
19710 url_beg : prefix match
19711 url_dir : subdir match
19712 url_dom : domain match
19713 url_end : suffix match
19714 url_len : length match
19715 url_reg : regex match
19716 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019718url_ip : ip
19719 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19720 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19721 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19722 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19723 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19724 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19725 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019727url_port : integer
19728 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19729 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19730 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19731 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019732
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019733urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19734url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019735 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19736 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019737 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19738 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19739 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19740 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019741 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19742 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019743 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19744 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019746 ACL derivatives :
19747 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19748 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19749 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19750 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19751 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19752 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19753 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19754 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019755
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019757 Example :
19758 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19759 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19760 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19761 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019762
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019763urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019764 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19765 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19766 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019767
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019768url32 : integer
19769 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19770 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19771 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19772 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19773 is an unsigned integer.
19774
19775url32+src : binary
19776 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19777 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19778 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19779
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019780
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200197817.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019782---------------------------------------
19783
19784This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19785used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19786purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19787There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19788or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19789any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19790for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19791
19792internal.htx.data : integer
19793 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19794 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19795
19796internal.htx.free : integer
19797 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19798 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19799
19800internal.htx.free_data : integer
19801 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19802 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19803
19804internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019805 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19806 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19807 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019808
19809internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19810 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19811 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19812
19813internal.htx.size : integer
19814 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19815 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19816
19817internal.htx.used : integer
19818 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19819 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19820 direction.
19821
19822internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19823 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19824 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19825 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19826 of the special value :
19827 * head : The oldest inserted block
19828 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019829 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019830
19831internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19832 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19833 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19834 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19835 integer or one of the special value :
19836 * head : The oldest inserted block
19837 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019838 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019839
19840internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19841 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19842 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19843 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19844 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19845
19846 * head : The oldest inserted block
19847 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019848 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019849
19850internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19851 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19852 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19853 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19854 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19855
19856 * head : The oldest inserted block
19857 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019858 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019859
19860internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19861 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19862 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19863 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19864 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19865
19866 * head : The oldest inserted block
19867 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019868 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019869
19870internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19871 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19872 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19873 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19874 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19875
19876 * head : The oldest inserted block
19877 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019878 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019879
19880internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19881 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19882 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19883 it returns false.
19884
19885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200198867.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019887---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019889Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19890every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019891order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019893ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019894---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19895FALSE always_false never match
19896HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19897HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19898HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019899HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019900HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19901HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19902HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19903HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19904LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19905METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19906METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19907METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19908METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19909METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19910METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19911METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19912METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19913RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19914REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19915TRUE always_true always match
19916WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19917---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019918
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199208. Logging
19921----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019922
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019923One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19924provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19925very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19926provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19927state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019928to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019929headers.
19930
19931In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19932about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19933send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19934
19935 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19936 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19937 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19938 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19939 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019940 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019941 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019942
19943The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19944allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19945as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19946while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19947real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19948delay.
19949
19950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199518.1. Log levels
19952---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019953
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019954TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019955source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019956HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19957in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19958track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19959syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19960about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019961
19962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199638.2. Log formats
19964----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019965
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019966HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019967and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19968slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19969options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019970
19971 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19972 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19973 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19974 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19975 extents.
19976
19977 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19978 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19979 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19980 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19981 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19982
19983 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19984 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19985 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19986 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19987 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19988
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019989 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19990 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19991 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19992 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19993
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019994 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19995
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019996Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19997specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19998field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19999servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20000always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20001identifier.
20002
20003Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20004 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20005 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20006 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20007 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20008
20009
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200108.2.1. Default log format
20011-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020012
20013This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20014as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20015format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20016
20017 Example :
20018 listen www
20019 mode http
20020 log global
20021 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20022
20023 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20024 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20025 (www/HTTP)
20026
20027 Field Format Extract from the example above
20028 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20029 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20030 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20031 4 'to' to
20032 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20033 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20034
20035Detailed fields description :
20036 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20037 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20038 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20039 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20040 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20041 and processed the connection.
20042 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20043
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020044In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20045"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20046connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20047
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020048It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20049will eventually disappear.
20050
20051
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200528.2.2. TCP log format
20053---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020054
20055The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20056is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20057information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20058counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20059emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20060environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20061the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20062sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020063specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20064not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20065fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20066marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020067
20068 Example :
20069 frontend fnt
20070 mode tcp
20071 option tcplog
20072 log global
20073 default_backend bck
20074
20075 backend bck
20076 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20077
20078 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20079 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20080 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20081
20082 Field Format Extract from the example above
20083 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20084 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20085 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20086 4 frontend_name fnt
20087 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20088 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20089 7 bytes_read* 212
20090 8 termination_state --
20091 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20092 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20093
20094Detailed fields description :
20095 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020096 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020097 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20098 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020099 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020100 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020101 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020102
20103 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020104 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20105 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20106 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020107
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020108 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020109 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20110 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020111 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20112 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20113 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20114 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020115
20116 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20117 and processed the connection.
20118
20119 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20120 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20121 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20122 applications.
20123
20124 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20125 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20126 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20127 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20128 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20129
20130 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20131 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20132 See "Timers" below for more details.
20133
20134 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20135 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20136 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20137 "Timers" below for more details.
20138
20139 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020140 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020141 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20142 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20143 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20144 details.
20145
20146 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20147 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20148 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20149 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20150 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20151
20152 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20153 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20154 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20155 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20156 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20157 for more details.
20158
20159 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020160 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020161 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20162 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20163 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020164 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020165
20166 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20167 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20168 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20169 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20170 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20171 caused by a denial of service attack.
20172
20173 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20174 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20175 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20176 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20177 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20178 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20179 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20180 denial of service attack.
20181
20182 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20183 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20184 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20185 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20186 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20187 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20188 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20189 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20190 be processed than on other servers.
20191
20192 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20193 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20194 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20195 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020196 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020197 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20198 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20199 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20200 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20201 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20202 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20203 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20204 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20205
20206 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20207 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20208 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20209 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20210 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20211 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020212 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020213 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20214
20215 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20216 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20217 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20218 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20219 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20220 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020221 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020222 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20223 occurs.
20224
20225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202268.2.3. HTTP log format
20227----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020228
20229The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20230is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20231the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20232are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20233emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20234generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20235"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20236which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020237frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20238is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020239
20240Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20241slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20242with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20243
20244 Example :
20245 frontend http-in
20246 mode http
20247 option httplog
20248 log global
20249 default_backend bck
20250
20251 backend static
20252 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20253
20254 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20255 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20256 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020257 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020258
20259 Field Format Extract from the example above
20260 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20261 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020262 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020263 4 frontend_name http-in
20264 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020265 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020266 7 status_code 200
20267 8 bytes_read* 2750
20268 9 captured_request_cookie -
20269 10 captured_response_cookie -
20270 11 termination_state ----
20271 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20272 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20273 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20274 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20275 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020276
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020277Detailed fields description :
20278 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020279 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020280 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20281 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020282 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020283 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020284 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020285
20286 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020287 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20288 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20289 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020290
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020291 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020292 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020293
20294 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20295 and processed the connection.
20296
20297 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20298 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20299 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20300
20301 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20302 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20303 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20304 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20305 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20306 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20307
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020308 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20309 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20310 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020311 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020312 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20313 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020314 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020315 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020316
20317 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20318 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020319 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020320
20321 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20322 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020323 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20324 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020325
20326 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20327 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20328 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20329 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20330 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020331 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20332 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020333
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020334 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020335 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20336 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20337 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20338 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20339 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20340 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020341 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020342
20343 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020344 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20345 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020346
20347 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20348 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020349 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020350 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20351 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20352 overflowing.
20353
20354 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20355 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20356 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20357 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20358 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20359 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20360 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20361 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20362
20363 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20364 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20365 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20366 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20367 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20368 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20369 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20370 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20371
20372 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20373 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20374 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20375 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20376 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20377 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20378 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20379
20380 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020381 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020382 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20383 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20384 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020385 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020386 system.
20387
20388 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20389 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20390 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20391 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20392 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20393 caused by a denial of service attack.
20394
20395 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20396 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20397 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20398 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20399 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20400 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20401 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20402 denial of service attack.
20403
20404 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20405 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20406 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20407 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20408 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20409 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20410 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20411 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20412 processed than on other servers.
20413
20414 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20415 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20416 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20417 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020418 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020419 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20420 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20421 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20422 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20423 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20424 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20425 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20426 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20427
20428 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20429 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20430 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20431 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20432 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20433 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020434 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020435 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20436
20437 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20438 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20439 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20440 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20441 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20442 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020443 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020444 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20445 occurs.
20446
20447 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20448 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20449 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20450 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20451 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20452 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20453 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20454 cookies" below for more details.
20455
20456 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20457 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20458 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20459 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20460 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20461 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20462 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20463 and cookies" below for more details.
20464
20465 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20466 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20467 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20468 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20469 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20470 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20471 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20472 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20473
20474
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200204758.2.4. Custom log format
20476------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020477
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020478The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020479mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020480
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020481HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020482Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20483separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20484prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20485
20486Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20487variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020488("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020489
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020490If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020491as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020492less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20493the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20494
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020495Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20496"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20497delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20498preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020499
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020500Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20501'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20502https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20503such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20504
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020505Flags are :
20506 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020507 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020508 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20509 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020510
20511 Example:
20512
20513 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20514 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20515
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020516 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20517
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020518At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20519
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020520 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20521 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020522
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020523the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020524
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020525 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20526 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20527 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020528
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020529and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20530
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020531 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20532 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020533
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020534Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20535
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020536 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020537 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020538 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20539 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20540 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020541 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20542 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20543 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020544 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020545 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020546 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020547 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020548 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020549 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20550 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020551 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020552 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020553 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020554 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020555 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020556 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020557 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020558 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20559 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20560 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20561 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20562 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020563 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020564 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020565 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020566 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020567 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020568 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20569 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020570 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20571 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20572 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020573 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020574 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20575 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020576 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020577 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20578 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20579 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020580 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020581 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020582 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20583 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20584 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20585 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020586 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020587 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020588 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020589 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020590 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020591 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020592 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20593 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20594 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020595 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020596 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20597 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020598 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020599 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20600 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020601 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020602 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020603 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020604 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020605
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020606 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020607
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020608
206098.2.5. Error log format
20610-----------------------
20611
20612When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020613protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020614By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20615"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020616will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020617logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20618
20619The format looks like this :
20620
20621 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20622 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20623 Connection error during SSL handshake
20624
20625 Field Format Extract from the example above
20626 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20627 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20628 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20629 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20630 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20631
20632These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20633failures.
20634
20635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206368.3. Advanced logging options
20637-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020638
20639Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20640just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20641options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20642for more information about their usage.
20643
20644
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206458.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20646------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020647
20648It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020649HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020650commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20651monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20652ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20653
20654 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20655 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20656 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20657 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20658
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020659 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20660 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020661
20662 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20663 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20664 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20665
20666
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206678.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20668----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020669
20670The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20671what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20672or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020673"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020674just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20675log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20676after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20677is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20678with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20679with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20680
20681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206828.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20683------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020684
20685Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20686for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20687"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20688retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20689raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20690a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20691file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20692you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20693"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20694
20695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206968.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20697--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020698
20699Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20700multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20701them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20702"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20703logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20704error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20705and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20706too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20707useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20708alternative.
20709
20710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207118.4. Timing events
20712------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020713
20714Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20715reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20716the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20717frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020718mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20719addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20720
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020721Timings events in HTTP mode:
20722
20723 first request 2nd request
20724 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20725 t tr t tr ...
20726 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20727 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20728 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20729 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020730 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020731 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20732
20733Timings events in TCP mode:
20734
20735 TCP session
20736 |<----------------->|
20737 t t
20738 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20739 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20740 |<------ Tt ------->|
20741
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020742 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020743 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020744 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20745 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20746 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020747 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020748 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20749 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20750 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20751 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020752
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020753 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20754 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20755 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020756 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20757 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20758 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20759 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20760 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20761 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020762
20763 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20764 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20765 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20766 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20767 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20768 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20769 request typed by hand during a test.
20770
20771 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20772 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020773 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020774 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20775 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20776 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20777 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020778
20779 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20780 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20781 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20782 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20783 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20784
20785 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20786 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20787 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20788 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20789 connection never established.
20790
20791 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20792 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20793 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20794 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20795 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20796 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20797 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20798 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20799 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20800 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20801 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20802
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020803 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20804 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20805 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20806 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20807 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20808 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20809
20810 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20811
20812 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20813 "Ta" can never be negative.
20814
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020815 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20816 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020817 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20818 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020819 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020820
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020821 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020822
20823 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020824 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20825 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020826
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020827 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20828 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20829 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20830 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20831 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20832 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20833 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20834 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20835
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020836These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20837protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20838that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020839due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20840"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20841that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020842
20843Most common cases :
20844
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020845 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20846 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20847 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20848 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20849 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020850 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020851 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20852 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20853 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20854 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20855 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020856 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020857
20858 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20859 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20860 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20861 of ms on remote networks.
20862
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020863 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20864 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20865 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020866
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020867 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20868 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020869 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020870 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20871 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20872 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20873 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20874 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20875 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020876
20877Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20878
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020879 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020880 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020881 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020882
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020883 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020884 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20885 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20886
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020887 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020888 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20889 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20890 flags.
20891
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020892 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20893 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020894 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20895 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20896 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20897 the client connection was maintained open.
20898
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020899 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020900 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020901 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020902 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20903
20904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209058.5. Session state at disconnection
20906-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020907
20908TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20909"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
209102-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20911each of which has a special meaning :
20912
20913 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20914 session to terminate :
20915
20916 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20917
20918 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20919 server explicitly refused it.
20920
20921 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20922 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20923 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20924 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020925 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020926
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020927 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020928 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020929
20930 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20931 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20932 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20933 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20934 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20935
20936 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20937 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20938 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20939 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20940 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20941
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020942 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020943 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20944
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020945 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020946 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20947 backup connections when going up.
20948
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020949 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020950
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020951 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20952 send or receive data.
20953
20954 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20955 send or receive data.
20956
20957 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20958 with nothing left in the buffers.
20959
20960 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20961
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020962 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020963 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20964
20965 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20966 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20967 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20968 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20969 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20970
20971 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20972 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20973
20974 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20975 server (HTTP only).
20976
20977 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20978
20979 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20980 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20981 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20982
20983 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20984 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20985 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20986
20987 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20988
20989 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20990 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20991
20992 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20993 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20994 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20995
20996 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20997 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020998 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20999 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021000
21001 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21002 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21003 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21004 another server.
21005
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021006 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021007 server.
21008
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021009 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21010 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21011 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21012 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21013
21014 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21015 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21016 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21017 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21018
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021019 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21020 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21021 "use-server" rule).
21022
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021023 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21024
21025 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21026 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21027
21028 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21029
21030 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21031 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21032 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21033
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021034 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21035 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021036 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021037 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21038 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21039
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021040 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21041
21042 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21043 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21044
21045 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21046
21047 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21048
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021049The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21050was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021051helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21052starvation, attacks, etc...
21053
21054The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21055alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21056easier finding and understanding.
21057
21058 Flags Reason
21059
21060 -- Normal termination.
21061
21062 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021063 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21064 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021065 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21066
21067 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21068 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021069 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21070 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021071 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21072 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021073
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021074 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21075 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021076 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021077
21078 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21079 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21080 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21081
21082 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21083 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21084 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21085 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21086 the server takes too long to respond.
21087
21088 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21089 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21090 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21091 long a time to respond.
21092
21093 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21094 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21095 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021096 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021097 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21098 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021099
21100 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21101 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21102 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21103 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21104 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021105 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021106 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21107 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21108 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21109 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21110 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21111 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21112 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21113 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021114 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021115 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21116 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21117 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021118
21119 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21120 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021121 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21122 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21123 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21124 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021125
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021126 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021127 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21128
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021129 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021130 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21131 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021132 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021133 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21134 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21135
21136 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21137 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21138 503 or 504 here.
21139
21140 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021141 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021142 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21143 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21144 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21145
21146 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21147 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021148 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021149 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021150 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021151
21152 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21153 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21154 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21155 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21156 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21157 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021158 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021159
21160 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21161 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21162 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21163 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21164 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21165 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21166 solution is to fix the application.
21167
21168 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21169 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21170 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21171 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21172 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21173 external attacks.
21174
21175 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021176 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021177 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021178 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21179 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21180
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021181 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21182 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21183 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021184 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021185 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021186
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021187 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21188 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21189 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21190 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021191 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21192 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21193 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21194 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21195 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021196
21197 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21198 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21199 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21200 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21201
21202 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21203 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21204 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21205 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21206
21207 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21208 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21209 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21210 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21211
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021212The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021213persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021214important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21215re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21216
21217 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21218
21219 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21220 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21221 set on a GET request.
21222
21223 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21224 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021225 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021226 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21227
21228 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21229 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21230 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21231
21232 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21233 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21234 already got a cookie.
21235
21236 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21237 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21238 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21239 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21240 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21241
21242 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21243 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21244 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21245
21246 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21247 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21248 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21249
21250 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21251 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21252
21253 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21254 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21255 then advertised in the response.
21256
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212588.6. Non-printable characters
21259-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021260
21261In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21262consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21263converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21264prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21265being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21266escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21267is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21268'}' when logging headers.
21269
21270Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21271issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21272containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21273
21274Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21275the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21276performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21277
21278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212798.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21280---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021281
21282Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21283achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021284section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021285cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21286the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21287the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021288locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021289not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21290user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21291a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21292wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21293
21294 Examples :
21295 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21296 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21297
21298 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21299 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21300
21301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213028.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21303---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021304
21305Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21306proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21307the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21308server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21309
21310Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21311response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021312section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021313
21314It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021315time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21316appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021317are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21318and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21319follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21320request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21321in the logs.
21322
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021323As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21324frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21325an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21326
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021327 Example :
21328 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21329 listen proxy-out
21330 mode http
21331 option httplog
21332 option logasap
21333 log global
21334 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21335
21336 # log the name of the virtual server
21337 capture request header Host len 20
21338
21339 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21340 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21341
21342 # log the beginning of the referrer
21343 capture request header Referer len 20
21344
21345 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21346 capture response header Server len 20
21347
21348 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21349 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21350
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021351 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021352 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21353
21354 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21355 capture response header Via len 20
21356
21357 # log the URL location during a redirection
21358 capture response header Location len 20
21359
21360 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21361 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21362 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21363 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21364 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21365
21366 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21367 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21368 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21369 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021370 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021371
21372 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21373 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21374 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21375 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21376 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021377 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021378
21379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213808.9. Examples of logs
21381---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021382
21383These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21384them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21385reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21386
21387 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21388 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21389 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21390
21391 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21392 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21393
21394 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21395 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21396 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21397
21398 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21399 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21400
21401 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21402 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21403 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21404
21405 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021406 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021407 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21408 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21409
21410 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21411 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21412 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21413
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021414 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21415 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21416 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21417 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021418 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021419 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021420
21421 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021422 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021423
21424 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21425 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21426 Nothing was sent to any server.
21427
21428 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21429 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21430
21431 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21432 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021433 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021434 send a 408 return code to the client.
21435
21436 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21437 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21438
21439 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21440 5 seconds ("c----").
21441
21442 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21443 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021444 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021445
21446 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021447 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021448 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21449 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21450 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21451 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21452 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021453
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021454
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200214559. Supported filters
21456--------------------
21457
21458Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21459accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21460unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21461
21462See also : "filter"
21463
214649.1. Trace
21465----------
21466
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021467filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021468
21469 Arguments:
21470 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21471 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21472
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021473 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021474
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021475 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021476 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21477 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21478 amount of the parsed data.
21479
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021480 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021481
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021482This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21483callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21484information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21485filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21486
21487Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21488tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21489a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21490
21491
214929.2. HTTP compression
21493---------------------
21494
21495filter compression
21496
21497The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21498keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021499when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21500fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21501done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21502explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21503filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21504listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21505order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021506
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021507See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21508 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021509
21510
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200215119.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21512--------------------------------------------
21513
21514filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21515
21516 Arguments :
21517
21518 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21519 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21520 parsed.
21521
21522 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21523 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21524 part must be placed in its own scope.
21525
21526The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21527external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021528streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021529exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21530also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21531
21532SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21533the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21534
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021535For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021536"doc/SPOE.txt".
21537
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100215389.4. Cache
21539----------
21540
21541filter cache <name>
21542
21543 Arguments :
21544
21545 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21546
21547The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21548"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021549cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021550other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21551case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21552is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21553filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021554listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21555order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021556
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021557See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21558 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21559
21560
215619.5. Fcgi-app
21562-------------
21563
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021564filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021565
21566 Arguments :
21567
21568 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21569
21570The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21571request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21572reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21573used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21574implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21575used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21576fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21577used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21578order.
21579
21580See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21581 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21582
21583
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100215849.6. OpenTracing
21585----------------
21586
21587The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21588HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21589of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21590Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21591
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021592This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021593
21594The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21595HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21596participates in the work of HAProxy.
21597
21598filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21599
21600 Arguments :
21601
21602 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21603 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21604 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21605 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21606 OpenTracing filters.
21607
21608 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21609 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21610 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21611 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21612 filter must have its own scope defined.
21613
21614More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021615of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021616
21617
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002161810. FastCGI applications
21619-------------------------
21620
21621HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21622feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21623the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21624FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21625servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21626FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21627backend.
21628
21629HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21630application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21631connection.
21632
2163310.1. Setup
21634-----------
21635
2163610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21637--------------------------
21638
21639fcgi-app <name>
21640 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21641 document root must be defined.
21642
21643acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21644 Declare or complete an access list.
21645
21646 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21647 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21648 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21649 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21650 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21651
21652docroot <path>
21653 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21654 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21655 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21656
21657index <script-name>
21658 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21659 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21660 is an optional setting.
21661
21662 Example :
21663 index index.php
21664
21665log-stderr global
21666log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021667 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021668 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21669
21670 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21671 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21672
21673pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21674 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21675 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21676 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21677
21678 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21679 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21680 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21681 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21682
21683 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21684 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21685
21686path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021687 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021688 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21689 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21690 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21691 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21692 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21693 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21694 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021695
21696 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021697 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021698 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21699 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21700 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21701 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021702
21703 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021704 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21705 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021706
21707option get-values
21708no option get-values
21709 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21710
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021711 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021712 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21713
21714 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21715 application will accept.
21716
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021717 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21718 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021719
21720 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021721 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021722 option is disabled.
21723
21724 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21725 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21726 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21727 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21728 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21729 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21730
21731option keep-conn
21732no option keep-conn
21733 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21734 sending a response.
21735
21736 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21737 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21738
21739option max-reqs <reqs>
21740 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21741 accept.
21742
21743 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21744 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21745 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21746 to 1.
21747
21748option mpxs-conns
21749no option mpxs-conns
21750 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21751
21752 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21753 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21754
21755set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21756 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21757 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21758 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21759 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21760
21761 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21762 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21763 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21764
21765 Example :
21766 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21767 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21768
21769 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21770
21771
2177210.1.2. Proxy section
21773---------------------
21774
21775use-fcgi-app <name>
21776 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21777
21778 Arguments :
21779 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21780
21781 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21782 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21783 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21784 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21785 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21786
21787 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21788 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21789 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21790 application are evaluated.
21791
21792
2179310.1.3. Example
21794---------------
21795
21796 frontend front-http
21797 mode http
21798 bind *:80
21799 bind *:
21800
21801 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21802 default_backend back-static
21803
21804 backend back-static
21805 mode http
21806 server www A.B.C.D:80
21807
21808 backend back-dynamic
21809 mode http
21810 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21811 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21812
21813 fcgi-app php-fpm
21814 log-stderr global
21815 option keep-conn
21816
21817 docroot /var/www/my-app
21818 index index.php
21819 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21820
21821
2182210.2. Default parameters
21823------------------------
21824
21825A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21826the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021827script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021828applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21829
21830 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21831 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21832 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21833 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21834 | | |
21835 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21836 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21837 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21838 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21839 | | application. |
21840 | | |
21841 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21842 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21843 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21844 | | |
21845 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21846 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21847 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21848 | | the application's configuration. |
21849 | | |
21850 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21851 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21852 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21853 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21854 | | |
21855 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21856 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21857 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21858 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21859 | | be defined. |
21860 | | |
21861 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21862 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21863 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21864 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21865 | | is not set too. |
21866 | | |
21867 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21868 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21869 | | set. |
21870 | | |
21871 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21872 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21873 | | the request. |
21874 | | |
21875 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21876 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21877 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21878 | | |
21879 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21880 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21881 | | script to process the request. |
21882 | | |
21883 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21884 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21885 | | |
21886 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21887 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21888 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21889 | | |
21890 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21891 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21892 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21893 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21894 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21895 | | |
21896 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21897 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21898 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21899 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21900 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21901 | | side. |
21902 | | |
21903 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21904 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21905 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21906 | | connected to. |
21907 | | |
21908 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21909 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21910 | | |
21911 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020021912 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
21913 | | current HAProxy version. |
21914 | | |
21915 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021916 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21917 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21918 | | |
21919 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21920
21921
2192210.3. Limitations
21923------------------
21924
21925The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21926way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21927during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21928establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21929application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21930or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21931message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21932these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21933and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21934
21935Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21936request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21937requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21938
21939About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21940into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21941fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21942"http-request" ones.
21943
21944Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21945FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21946processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21947must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21948here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021949
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021950
2195111. Address formats
21952-------------------
21953
21954Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21955address.
21956
21957This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21958The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21959of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21960equivalent is '::'.
21961
21962Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21963is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21964
21965This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21966family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21967
21968Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21969configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21970use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21971'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21972
21973Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21974socket type and the transport method.
21975
21976
2197711.1 Address family prefixes
21978----------------------------
21979
21980'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21981
21982'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21983 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21984 listening.
21985
21986'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21987 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21988 on the statement using this address, a port or
21989 a port range may or must be specified.
21990
21991'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21992 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21993 using this address, a port or a port range
21994 may or must be specified.
21995
21996'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21997 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21998 using this address, a port or a port range
21999 may or must be specified.
22000
22001'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22002 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22003 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22004 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22005 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22006 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22007
22008'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22009 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22010 start by slash '/'.
22011
22012
2201311.2 Socket type prefixes
22014-------------------------
22015
22016Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22017type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22018this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22019This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22020but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22021
22022Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22023instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22024
22025If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22026they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22027report this to the maintainers.
22028
22029'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22030 to "stream"
22031
22032'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22033 to "datagram".
22034
22035
2203611.3 Protocol prefixes
22037----------------------
22038
22039'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22040 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22041 socket type and transport method is forced to
22042 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22043 this address, a port or a port range can or
22044 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22045 of 'stream+ip@'.
22046
22047'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22048 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22049 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22050 statement using this address, a port or port
22051 range can or must be specified.
22052 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22053
22054'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22055 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22056 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22057 statement using this address, a port or port
22058 range can or must be specified.
22059 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22060
22061'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22062 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22063 socket type and transport method is forced to
22064 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22065 this address, a port or a port range can or
22066 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22067 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22068
22069'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22070 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22071 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22072 the statement using this address, a port or
22073 port range can or must be specified.
22074 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22075
22076'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22077 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22078 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22079 the statement using this address, a port or
22080 port range can or must be specified.
22081 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22082
22083'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22084 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22085 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22086
22087'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22088 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22089 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22090
22091In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22092QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22093
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022094/*
22095 * Local variables:
22096 * fill-column: 79
22097 * End:
22098 */